7145 7235 7228 7222 Field Service PDF
7145 7235 7228 7222 Field Service PDF
7145 7235 7228 7222 Field Service PDF
7145/7235/7228
7222
2004. 03
Ver. 4.0
2004 KONICA MINOLTA BUSINESS TECHNOLOGIES, INC.
Printed in Japan
Use of this manual should be strictly supervised to
N40LF0000
avoid disclosure of confidential information.
Company names and commodity names mentioned in this service manual are the brand names or registered trade-
marks of each company.
After publication of this service manual, the parts and mechanism may be subject to change for improvement of their
performance. Therefore, the descriptions given in this service manual may not coincide with the actual machine.
When any change has been made to the descriptions in the service manual, a revised version will be issued with a
revision mark added as required.
Revision mark:
To indicate clearly a section revised, show to the left of the revised section.
A number within represents the number of times the revision has been made.
To indicate clearly a section revised, show 1 in the lower outside section of the corresponding page.
A number within 1 represents the number of times the revision has been made.
Note:
Revision marks shown in a page are restricted only to the latest ones with the old ones deleted.
When a page revised in Ver. 2.0 has been changed in Ver. 3.0:
The revision marks for Ver. 3.0 only are shown with those for Ver. 2.0 deleted.
When a page revised in Ver. 2.0 has not been changed in Ver. 3.0:
The revision marks for Ver. 2.0 are left as they are.
CONTENTS
I ADJUSTMENT
SAFETY AND IMPORTANT WARNING ITEMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-1
II ISW
INDICATION OF WARNING ON THE MACHINE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S-13
I ADJUSTMENT
1. HOW TO USE THE ADJUSTMENT SECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
1.1 Composition. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
2. ADJUSTMENTS WHEN REPLACING PARTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
3. LIST OF ADJUSTMENT ITEMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2
III SERVICE
4. CE PASSWORD SETTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
5. MODE CHANGE MENU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
5.1 Setting method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
6. CHECKING BY THE COUNTER KEY FUNCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5
6.1 Checking method of the counter key function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5
7. 25 MODE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6
7.1 Setting method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8
7.2 Setting software DIPSW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8
7.3 PM count setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-30
IV DIAGRAMS
7.3.1 PM count reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-30
7.3.2 Entering PM count start date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-30
7.3.3 Setting of PM cycle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-30
7.3.4 Counter clear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-30
7.4 Data collection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-31
7.5 Copy count for each part to be replaced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-37
7.5.1 Copy count by parts to be replaced (fixed). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-37
7.5.2 Copy count by parts to be replaced (Named; arbitrarily) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-39
7.6 Password setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-41
7.7 Setting phone number of the service center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-42
7.8 Setting the serial number/the destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-42
7.8.1 Setting the serial number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-42
7.8.2 Setting the destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-43
7.9 Displaying the ROM version . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-43
7.10 KRDS setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-43
7.11 ISW setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-43
7.12 Root counter display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-43
7.13 Setting date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-44
7.14 Tray size setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-44
i 3
CONTENTS 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
8. 36 MODE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-45
8.1 Setting method. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-45
I ADJUSTMENT
3 ii
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 CONTENTS
I ADJUSTMENT
10.4 RADF original skew adjustment (back side) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-92
10.5 DB-411 paper-centering adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-94
10.6 DB-411 tray tilt adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-95
10.7 LT tray tilt adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-96
10.8 FS-113 Output Check Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-98
10.9 Lengthwise position adjustment of punch hole of FS-113 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-103
10.10Adjustment of FS-113 Solenoids . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-104
10.11FS-113 Timing Belt Tension Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-105
10.12FS-113 Adjustment of the Elevator Tray Upper Limit Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-106
10.13Adjustment of FS-113 Elevator Tray Overload Detection Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-107
II ISW
10.14Staple Position Adjustment of FS-114. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-108
10.15Adjustment of the Installation Position of the Shutter Drive Gear of FS-114 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-109
10.16Punch Hole Deviance Adjustment of FS-114 (PK-114) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-110
10.17Fold Angle Adjustment of SK-114 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-111
10.18Staple Angle Adjustment of SK-114 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-112
II ISW
III SERVICE
1. DESCRIPTION OF THE ISW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
2. SETUP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
3. USB ISW. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5
III SERVICE
1. SERVICE SCHEDULE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
1.1 Service schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
1.1.1 7145 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1
IV DIAGRAMS
1.1.2 7235 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2
1.1.3 7228/7222 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
1.2 Maintenance items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5
1.2.1 7145 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5
1.2.2 7235/7228/7222 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
1.2.3 DF-318/320 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7
1.2.4 DB-211/411 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8
1.2.5 LT-203 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8
1.2.6 FS-112 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8
1.2.7 FS-113/RU-101 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9
1.2.8 FS-114 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9
1.2.9 PK-114 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9
1.2.10 SK-114 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10
1.2.11 BK-114 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10
1.3 Periodic check items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11
1.3.1 7145 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11
1.3.2 7235/7228/7222 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13
1.3.3 DF-318 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15
1.3.4 DF-320 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15
iii 3
CONTENTS 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
IV DIAGRAMS
1. PARTS LAYOUT DRAWING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1
II ISW
3 iv
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 CONTENTS
I ADJUSTMENT
6.3 LT-203 Overall Wiring Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-95
6.4 FS-112 Overall Wiring Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-97
6.5 RU-101 Overall Wiring Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-99
6.6 FS-113 Overall Wiring Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-101
6.7 SK-114 Overall Wiring Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-103
7. APPENDIX
7.1 7145 Overall Wiring Diagram (1/4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix-1
7.2 7145 Overall Wiring Diagram (2/4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix-2
7.3 7145 Overall Wiring Diagram (3/4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix-3
7.4 7145 Overall Wiring Diagram (4/4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix-4
II ISW
7.5 7235/7228/7222 Overall Wiring Diagram (1/4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix-6
7.6 7235/7228/7222 Overall Wiring Diagram (2/4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix-7
7.7 7235/7228/7222 Overall Wiring Diagram (3/4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix-8
7.8 7235/7228/7222 Overall Wiring Diagram (4/4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix-9
7.9 FS-114 Overall Wiring Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Appendix-11
III SERVICE
IV DIAGRAMS
v 3
CONTENTS 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
I ADJUSTMENT
II ISW
III SERVICE
Blank page
IV DIAGRAMS
vi
SAFETY AND IMPORTANT WARNING ITEMS
IMPORTANT NOTICE
Because of possible hazards to an inexperienced person servicing this copier as well as the risk of damage to
the copier, Konica Minolta Business Technologies, INC. (hereafter called the KMBT) strongly recommends that
all servicing be performed only by KMBT-trained service technicians.
Changes may have been made to this copier to improve its performance after this Service Manual was printed.
Accordingly, KMBT does not warrant, either explicitly or implicitly, that the information contained in this Service
Manual is complete and accurate.
The user of this Service Manual must assume all risks of personal injury and/or damage to the copier while ser-
vicing the copier for which this Service Manual is intended.
Therefore, this Service Manual must be carefully read before doing service work both in the course of technical
training and even after that, for performing maintenance and control of the copier properly.
Keep this Service Manual also for future service.
Symbols used for safety and important warning items are defined as follows:
:Precaution when using the copier. General precaution Electric hazard High temperature
S-1 1
SAFETY AND IMPORTANT WARNING ITEMS
SAFETY WARNINGS
Using any fuse or thermostat not specified by KMBT. Safety will not be
assured, leading to a risk of fire and injury.
Disabling fuse functions or bridging fuse terminals with wire, metal clips, sol-
der or similar object.
Disabling safety functions (interlocks, safety circuits, etc.) Safety will not be
assured, leading to a risk of fire and injury.
1 S-2
SAFETY AND IMPORTANT WARNING ITEMS
[2] CHECKPOINTS WHEN PERFORMING ON-SITE SERVICE
Konica Minolta brand copiers are extensively tested before shipping, to ensure that all applicable safety standards are met,
in order to protect the customer and customer engineer (hereafter called the CE) from the risk of injury. However, in daily
use, any electrical equipment may be subject to parts wear and eventual failure. In order to maintain safety and reliability,
the CE must perform regular safety checks.
1.Power Supply
If two or more power cords can be plugged into the wall outlet, the total load
must not exceed the rating of the wall outlet.
If excessive current flows in the wall outlet, fire may result.
Make sure the power cord is plugged in the wall outlet securely.
Contact problems may lead to increased resistance, overheating, and the
risk of fire.
Check whether the power cord is damaged. Check whether the sheath is
damaged.
If the power plug, cord, or sheath is damaged, replace with a new power
cord (with plugs on both ends) specified by KMBT. Using the damaged
power cord may result in fire or electric shock.
When using the power cord (inlet type) that came with this copier, be sure to
observe the following precautions:
a. Make sure the copier-side power plug is securely inserted in the socket
on the rear panel of the copier.
Secure the cord with a fixture properly.
b. If the power cord or sheath is damaged, replace with a new power cord
(with plugs on both ends) specified by KMBT.
If the power cord (inlet type) is not connected to the copier securely, a
contact problem may lead to increased resistance, overheating, and risk
of fire.
Check whether the power cord is not stepped on or pinched by a table and
so on.
Overheating may occur there, leading to a risk of fire.
S-3 1
SAFETY AND IMPORTANT WARNING ITEMS
Check whether dust is collected around the power plug and wall outlet.
Using the power plug and wall outlet without removing dust may result in
fire.
Do not insert the power plug into the wall outlet with a wet hand.
The risk of electric shock exists.
When unplugging the power cord, grasp the plug, not the cable.
The cable may be broken, leading to a risk of fire and electric shock.
WARNING: Wiring
Never use multi-plug adapters to plug multiple power cords in the same out-
let.
If used, the risk of fire exists.
S-4
SAFETY AND IMPORTANT WARNING ITEMS
2.Installation Requirements
Do not place the copier in a place exposed to water such as rain water.
A risk of fire and electric shock exists.
When the copier is not used over an extended period of time (holidays, etc.),
switch it off and unplug the power cord.
Dust collected around the power plug and outlet may cause fire.
CAUTION: Ventilation
Do not place the copier in a place where there is much dust, cigarette
smoke, or ammonia gas.
Place the copier in a well ventilated place to prevent machine problems
and image faults.
S-5
SAFETY AND IMPORTANT WARNING ITEMS
CAUTION: Ventilation
The copier generates ozone gas during operation, but it is not sufficient to be
harmful to the human body.
If a bad smell of ozone is present in the following cases, ventilate the
room.
a. When the copier is used in a poorly ventilated room
b. When taking a lot of copies
c. When using multiple copiers at the same time
CAUTION: Vibration
When installing the copier, read the Installation Guide thoroughly. Be sure to
install the copier in a level and sturdy place.
Constant vibration will cause problems.
3 S-6
SAFETY AND IMPORTANT WARNING ITEMS
Take every care when servicing with the external cover detached.
High-voltage exists around the drum unit. A risk of electric shock exists.
Do not allow any metal parts such as clips, staples, and screws to fall into the
copier.
They can short internal circuits and cause electric shock or fire.
Carefully remove all toner remnants and dust from electrical parts and elec-
trode units such as a charging corona unit.
Current can leak, leading to a risk of copier trouble or fire.
Check electrode units such as a charging corona unit for deterioration and
sign of leakage.
Current can leak, leading to a risk of trouble or fire.
Do not remove the cover of the write unit. Do not supply power with the write
unit shifted from the specified mounting position.
The laser light can enter your eye, leading to a risk of loss of eyesight.
When replacing a lithium battery, replace it with a new lithium battery speci-
fied in the Parts Guide Manual. Dispose of the used lithium battery using the
method specified by local authority.
Improper replacement can cause explosion.
S-7
SAFETY AND IMPORTANT WARNING ITEMS
After replacing a part to which AC voltage is applied (e.g., optical lamp and
fixing lamp), be sure to check the installation state.
A risk of fire exists.
Check the interlock switch and actuator for loosening and check whether the
interlock functions properly.
If the interlock does not function, you may receive an electric shock or be
injured when you insert your hand in the copier (e.g., for clearing paper
jam).
Make sure the wiring cannot come into contact with sharp edges, burrs, or
other pointed parts.
Current can leak, leading to a risk of electric shock or fire.
Make sure that all screws, components, wiring, connectors, etc. that were
removed for safety check and maintenance have been reinstalled in the orig-
inal location. (Pay special attention to forgotten connectors, pinched cables,
forgotten screws, etc.)
A risk of copier trouble, electric shock, and fire exists.
S-8
SAFETY AND IMPORTANT WARNING ITEMS
Do not replace the cover or turn the copier ON before any solvent remnants
on the cleaned parts have fully evaporated.
A risk of fire exists.
Use only a small amount of cleaner at a time and take care not to spill any
liquid. If this happens, immediately wipe it off.
A risk of fire exists.
[4] CONCLUSION
1. Safety of users and customer engineers depends highly on accurate maintenance and administration. Therefore,
safety can be maintained by the appropriate daily service work conducted by the customer engineer.
2. When performing service, each copier on the site must be tested for safety. The customer engineer must verify the
safety of parts and ensure appropriate management of the equipment.
S-9 1
SAFETY AND IMPORTANT WARNING ITEMS
SAFETY INFORMATION
IMPORTANT INFORMATION
The Center for Devices and Radiological Health (CDRH) of the U.S. Food and Drug Administration implemented
regulations for laser products manufactured since August 1, 1976. Compliance is mandatory for products mar-
keted in the United States.
S-10
SAFETY AND IMPORTANT WARNING ITEMS
SAFETY CIRCUITS
This machine is provided with the following safety circuits [2] L2 and L3 (fixing heater lamp/1, /2)
to prevent machine faults from resulting in serious acci-
overheating prevention circuit
dents.
L2
L3
TH2
order to prevent servicing errors that may impair their
functions.
TH1
Control
AC driver
[1] Overall protection circuit section
section
FCB
CBR1
1. Protection by software
DCPS The output voltage from TH1, TH2 (fixing temper-
ature sensor/1, /2) is read by the CPU. If this volt-
CBR2
age is abnormal, L2 (fixing heater lamp/1), L3
(fixing heater lamp/2) and RL1 (main relay) are
turned OFF.
1. Protection by CBR1 and CBR2 (circuit CAUTION:
breaker/1, /2) The RL1 function must not be deactivated
CBR1 and CBR2 interrupt the AC line instanta- under any circumstances.
neously when an excessive current flows due to a
short in the AC line.
CAUTION:
The CBR1 and CBR2 functions must not
be deactivated under any circumstances.
S-11
SAFETY AND IMPORTANT WARNING ITEMS
2. Protection by the hardware circuit
The output voltages from TH1, TH2 (fixing tem-
perature sensor/1, /2) are compared with the abnor-
mality judgment reference value in the comparator
circuit. If the output voltage from TH1 or TH2
exceeds the reference value, L2 (fixing heater lamp/
1), L3 (fixing heater lamp/2) and RL1 (main relay)
are turned OFF in hardware means.
CAUTION:
Periodically check the TH1, TH2 face
contacting the roller, and replace TH2 if
any abnormality is detected.
The RL1 function must not be deactivated
under any circumstances.
3. Protection by TS (thermostat)
When the fixing heat roller exceeds the specified
value, TSs (thermostats) are turned OFF, thus inter-
rupting the power to L2 (fixing heater lamp/1), and
L3 (fixing heater lamp/2) directly.
CAUTION:
Do not use any other electrical conductor
in place of TS1 and TS2.
3 S-12
SAFETY AND IMPORTANT WARNING ITEMS
CAUTION
CAUTION
CAUTION
You may be burned or injured if you touch any area that you are advised by any caution label to keep your-
self away from.
Do not remove caution labels. If any caution label has come off or soiled and therefore the caution cannot
be read, contact our Service Office.
S-13 3
SAFETY AND IMPORTANT WARNING ITEMS
<7235/7228/7222>
7322sf002e
CAUTION
You may be burned or injured if you touch any area that you are advised by any caution label to keep your-
self away from.
Do not remove caution labels. If any caution label has come off or soiled and therefore the caution cannot
be read, contact our Service Office.
3 S-14
SAFETY AND IMPORTANT WARNING ITEMS
2. Front side
<7145>
7322sf003e
CAUTION
You may be burned or injured if you touch any area that you are advised by any caution label to keep your-
self away from.
Do not remove caution labels. If any caution label has come off or soiled and therefore the caution cannot
be read, contact our Service Office.
S-15 3
SAFETY AND IMPORTANT WARNING ITEMS
<7235/7228/7222>
7322sf004e
CAUTION
You may be burned or injured if you touch any area that you are advised by any caution label to keep your-
self away from.
Do not remove caution labels. If any caution label has come off or soiled and therefore the caution cannot
be read, contact our Service Office.
3 S-16
SAFETY AND IMPORTANT WARNING ITEMS
3. Rear/Left side (7235/7228/7222 only)
7322sf005e
CAUTION
You may be burned or injured if you touch any area that you are advised by any caution label to keep your-
self away from.
Do not remove caution labels. If any caution label has come off or soiled and therefore the caution cannot
be read, contact our Service Office.
S-17 3
SAFETY AND IMPORTANT WARNING ITEMS
4. Scanner section
<7145>
7322sf006
CAUTION
You may be burned or injured if you touch any area that you are advised by any caution label to keep your-
self away from.
Do not remove caution labels. If any caution label has come off or soiled and therefore the caution cannot
be read, contact our Service Office.
3 S-18
SAFETY AND IMPORTANT WARNING ITEMS
<7235/7228/7222>
7322sf007e
CAUTION
You may be burned or injured if you touch any area that you are advised by any caution label to keep your-
self away from.
Do not remove caution labels. If any caution label has come off or soiled and therefore the caution cannot
be read, contact our Service Office.
S-19 3
SAFETY AND IMPORTANT WARNING ITEMS
[2] FS-113
CAUTION
CAUTION
[3] FS-114
FS-114 Finisher
7322sf010
CAUTION
You may be burned or injured if you touch any area that you are advised by any caution label to keep your-
self away from.
Do not remove caution labels. If any caution label has come off or soiled and therefore the caution cannot
be read, contact our Service Office.
3 S-20
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 HOW TO USE THE ADJUSTMENT SECTION
I ADJUSTMENT
Be sure to pay due attention to the following
1. HOW TO USE THE when repairing the machine.
ADJUSTMENT SECTION
1. Only one side of the AC power line is discon-
1.1 Composition nected when the main power of this machine is
turned off. Always unplug the machine before
This section details adjusting items and procedures. beginning work. If absolutely necessary to work
with the power on, exercise care to avoid being
A. Checking before starting work caught in the scanning rear of the exposure unit.
Use this section for making adjustments and as 2. Special care should be taken when handling the
a checklist before implementing corrective fixing unit since it operates at extremely high
measures in the field. temperatures.
3. The developing unit is surrounded by a strong
1. Does the power supply meet the requirements? magnetic field. Keep watches and metering
2. Is the power supply properly grounded? equipment away from it.
3. Is the machine sharing its power source with 4. Avoid scarring the drum with tools or similar
another high current consumption machine that objects.
draws large currents intermittently? (e.g. an ele- 5. Do not touch IC pins with your bare hands.
vator, air conditioner, or other source of electri-
cal consumption) 2. ADJUSTMENTS WHEN
4. Is the installation environment suitable? REPLACING PARTS
The machine must be installed in a wellventi-
lated place free from high temperature, high Adjustments (including checks) and settings are not
humidity and direct sunlight. only required when a defective copy image occurs,
The machine must be installed on a level but also after replacing or reinstalling certain parts.
floor.
5. Does the cause of a defective image lie in the [How to use the tables]
original itself? The following items are used in the tables through-
6. Is the density adjusting control at the proper out this section.
position? 1. Mode
7. Are the platen glass and the slit glass clean? Indicates the adjustment mode.
8. Is the correct paper being used for the copy? 25 : 25 mode
9. Are the copying materials and parts replaced 36 : 36 mode
when they reach the end of their usable life? 47 : 47 mode
(developer, drum, cleaning blade, etc.)
10. Is there toner in the toner bottle? 2. Symbols used in the tables
, ................. : Indicates there is a pri-
ority sequence for
adjustments (including
checks) and settings.
{ (Empty circle) : Indicates adjustments
(including checks) and
settings that can be car-
ried out independently.
1-1
LIST OF ADJUSTMENT ITEMS 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
Write unit
E-RDH
RADF
Mode
Drum
Page
1 PM counter resetting 25 1-30 { {
3 1-2
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 LIST OF ADJUSTMENT ITEMS
I ADJUSTMENT
items
Write unit
E-RDH
RADF
Mode
Drum
Page
16 Image adjustment Timing Image read point
36 1-58 { {
adjustment adjustment
*1 After replacing the developer, be sure that you do not make any copies until you have first carried out L
detection adjustment.
*2 When PRMB (Parameter memory board) is replaced, remember to replaced the developer before con-
ducting the L deection adjustment.
Note:
When replacing a board due to the SCB (System control board) being damaged, the PRMB (Parameter
memory board) that was installed on the damaged SCB should be used as a rule on the new SCB.
The use of a new PRMB should be limited only when it is considered that the PRMB is also damaged.
On this occasion, adjustment data have not been input into the new PRMB and it is necessary to imple-
ment all of the adjustment items. In order to make the new PRMB effective, the 47 mode - 92 (output)
should be carried out before implementation of the adjustment items.
When the adjustment items have been implemented, the 47 mode - 96 (output) should be also executed.
The adjustment data are backed up by implementing the 47-96 mode.
For the original PRMB installed on the damaged SCB, the 47-92 mode is protected against inadvertent
execution. For details of the cancellation of protection, contact the service manager of the authorized dis-
tributor.
1-3 3
CE PASSWORD SETTING 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
Note:
Only alphanumerical keys can be used for the
password. Continuous single alphanumeric can-
not be used for the password.
In order to change the registered password, in the
above step 3, enter current password and con-
tinue following steps.
Do not use name, your birthday or employee
code number as the password since other people
can easily guess them.
CE should not inform other people of the pass-
word.
2 1-4
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 CHECKING BY THE COUNTER KEY FUNCTION
6. CHECKING BY THE
COUNTER KEY FUNCTION
I ADJUSTMENT
The Counter key function enables to display of the
following parameters by using the counter button:
1 Total count
2 Total count start date
3 PM count/PM count limit
4 PM count start date
5 Fax send paper count
6 Fax receive paper count
7 Printer count
8 Scanner count
9 Drum count
10 Developing count
11 Fixing unit count
1-5
25 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
7. 25 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
2. PM CYCLE set
1-6
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 25 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
7. Serial number 1. Main body Sets up the serial
setting number display and
2. Optional tray
the destination.
3. LCT
4. Finisher
5. Fax
6. Printer
7. FL-102/FL-103
10.RADF (7235/7228/7222)
1-7 3
25 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
C. Procedure
1. Enter the 25 Mode.
2. 25 mode menu screen
Press the [Software SW] key.
3. Software setting screen
Select DIP switch number.
Use the arrow key on the left.
4. Select bit number of the DIP switch.
Use the arrow key at the center.
5. Select ON (=1) or OFF (=0) of the DIP switch.
Use [ON] or [OFF] key.
[ON] : Set bit.
[OFF] : Clear bit.
6. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the 25
mode menu screen.
For each switch function, see List of software
DIPSW.
2 1-8
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 25 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
Note:
Be sure not to change bits with no particular reference made of the function.
2 0 0 0
5 0 0 0
6 0 0 0
DIPSW2 0 Toner replenish stop timing 1 Decide with Stop after paper 0 0 0
DIPSW 3-2 exited
1 0 0 0
2 1 1 1
3 1 1 1
4 0 0 0
6 1 1 1
1-9 3
25 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
4 1 1 1
5 0 0 0
6 0 0 0
7 0 0 0
7 0 0 0
DIPSW5 0 0 1 0
1 0 0 1
2 0 0 0
3 0 0 0
4 0 0 0
7 0 0 0
DIPSW6 0 0 0 0
3 0 0 0
3 1-10
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 25 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
Japan Inch Metric
7 0 0 0
DIPSW8 0 1 0 0
3 0 0 0
6 0 0 0
1-11
25 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
2 0 0 0
3 0 0 0
4 0 0 0
5 0 0 0
7 0 0 0
1 1 1 1
2 1 1 1
3 0 0 0
5 0 0 0
1 0 0 0
2 0 0 0
3 0 0 0
4 0 0 0
5 0 0 0
6 0 0 0
7 0 0 0
1-12
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 25 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
Japan Inch Metric
DIPSW12 0 0 0 0
1 0 0 0
2 0 0 0
5 0 0 0
DIPSW13 0 0 0 0
1 0 0 0
2 0 0 0
4 0 0 0
5 0 0 0
2 0 1 0
3 0 1 0
* Common to FS-112/113
1-13
25 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
DIPSW15 0 0 0 0
1 0 0 0
2 0 0 0
3 0 0 0
4 0 0 0
5 0 0 0
4 0 0 0
5 0 0 0
7 *b *b *b
DIPSW17 0 F4 size setting *23 *23 0 0 0
1 0 0 0
2 0 0 0
4 0 0 0
6 0 0 0
3 1-14
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 25 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
Japan Inch Metric
2 0 0 0
3 0 0 0
2 0 0 0
6 0 0 0
1-15 3
25 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
3 0 0 0
6 0 0 0
7 0 0 0
3 1-16
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 25 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
Japan Inch Metric
DIPSW22 0 1 1 1
2 0 0 0
3 0 0 0
5 0 0 0
6 0 0 0
7 1 1 1
6 0 0 0
1-17 3
25 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
DIPSW24 0 0 0 0
1 1 1 1
4 0 1 0
5 0 0 1
2 0 0 0
4 0 0 0
DIPSW26 0 0 0 0
1 0 0 0
2 1 1 1
5 0 0 0
3 1-18
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 25 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
Japan Inch Metric
3 0 0 0
2 0 0 0
3 0 0 0
6 0 0 0
7 0 0 0
5 0 0 0
6 1 1 1
1-19 3
25 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
5 0 0 0
6 0 0 0
7 0 0 0
4 0 0 0
5 0 0 0
3 0 0 0
5 1 1 1
6 0 0 0
3 1-20
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 25 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
Japan Inch Metric
1 0 0 0
5 0 0 0
2 0 0 0
3 0 0 0
1 0 0 0
2 0 0 0
3 0 0 0
4 0 0 0
5 0 0 0
6 0 0 0
7 0 0 0
1-21 3
25 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
1 1 1 1
2 0 0 0
3 0 0 0
4 0 0 0
5 0 0 0
6 0 0 0
7 0 0 0
3 1-22
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 25 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
potential by 50V (20 step) in this setting allows
50 sheets 0 0
the consumption of toner to be reduced.
45 sheets 0 1
Increasing the potential by 50V (20 step)
40 sheets 1 0
allows the image density to increase a little.
35 sheets 1 1
Mode 5-6 5-5
No adjustment 0 0
*2 Toner level detection (toner supply display) Toner consumption 0 1
After the TLD (Toner level sensor) detects the increased (image den-
no toner condition for more than a specified sity increased)
period of time, this sets a timing for displaying Toner consumption 1 0
the message Please supply toner. decreased (image den-
sity decreased )
Mode 4-1 4-0 No adjustment 1 1
0 effective copies 0 0
100 effective copies 0 1
*6 Timing for the polygon motor to stop/start a
200 effective copies 1 0
low speed rotation
500 effective copies 1 1
When the setting of the polygon motor is
made for stopping or a low speed rotation, the
*3 Condition for stopping copying after toner sup- motor is shifted into a low speed rotation or
ply display stopping after the elapse of time specified by
After displaying a message set in DIPSW4-0/- this DIPSW. The elapsed time starts either at
1, the count up to which the copy is prohibited one of the following:
is set. When the warm-up is completed.
When the final operation of the operation keys
Mode 4-3 4-2
(except the start key)/RADF/tray while in idling.
100 effective copies 0 0
When the output of a copy or print job is com-
400 effective copies 0 1
pleted.
700 effective copies 1 0
1000 effective copies 1 1 Mode 6-5 6-4
15 seconds 0 0
30 seconds 0 1
60 seconds 1 0
120 seconds 1 1
1-23 1
25 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
*7 Setting of the polygon motor for stopping or *10 Automatic conversion of the APS detected
low speed rotation paper size (8.5 x 11/A4)
I ADJUSTMENT
In order to reduce the sound of rotation of the The paper size detected by the APS is auto-
polygon motor while in idling, it is possible to matically converted according to the standard
switch the rotation of the polygon motor either shown below before being copied.
to a low speed rotation or stopping. The timing
Mode 7-2
for the switching is set based on *6 Timing for
No automatic conversion 0
the polygon motor to stop/start a low speed
A4 8.5 x 11 (Inch) 1
rotation. When the polygon motor is stopped
8.5 x 11 A4 (Japan, Metric)
or rotating at low speed, the time required for
the first copy being made is increased.
1-24
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 25 MODE
*13 Copy quantity limit *17 Judging level in the out-of-original auto era-
sure mode
Mode 9-3 9-2 9-1 9-0
I ADJUSTMENT
This setting is for the application function of
No limit 0 0 0 0
the out-of-original auto erasure mode. When
1 sheet 0 0 0 1
the out-of-original auto erasure is set to auto-
3 sheets 0 0 1 0
matic in the key operator mode, a threshold
5 sheets 0 0 1 1
value is set for detection of the original area.
9 sheets 0 1 0 0
10 sheets 0 1 0 1 Mode 13-7 13-6
20 sheets 0 1 1 0 Thick original 0 0
30 sheets 0 1 1 1 Normal original 0 1
50 sheets 1 0 0 0 Corresponding to 1 0
99 sheets 1 0 0 1 hybrid lights
1 1
1-25
25 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
*20 Operation when two position stapling is not *23 F4 size setting
available
Mode 17-2 17-1 17-0
I ADJUSTMENT
3 1-26
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 25 MODE
*26 Automatic feed of non-standard size originals *30 Automatic copy reservation function
in the platen auto start mode When this setting is 1, the copy reservation
I ADJUSTMENT
The setting of the automatic selection of auto- screen automatically appears after the end of
start is available for the memory switch setting the original read operation. Also, the job set-
in the key operator mode. When this setting is tings are the same as the settings for the pre-
in the following condition, a setting can be vious job.
made to decide if the paper is automatically
Mode 27-0
fed from the by-pass tray.
Do not use 0
The setting of the automatic selection of auto-
Use 1
start is on with the original size (platen) detected
as non-standard.
Mode 22-1
*31 Density setting when the toner save function
is selected in the printer driver screen
Auto start does not take place 0
When Toner saving mode is on in the printer
Auto start takes place when the by- 1
driver, the print density is set in the range
pass tray is selected
shown below.
This setting is effective only for the PCL and
*27 Printer paper size automatic conversion PS versions.
The paper size specified by the print job is Mode 27-7 27-6 27-5
automatically changed and output according Standard 0 0 0
to the following standard.
-4 (Lighter) 0 0 1
Mode 24-2 24-3 -3 0 1 0
No conversion 0 0 -2 0 1 1
Inch Metric 0 1 -1 1 0 0
Metric Inch 1 0 +1 1 0 1
Non (not allowed to 1 1 +2 1 1 0
select) +3 (Darker) 1 1 1
Mode 24-7
No process stop 0
Process stop 1
1-27 1
25 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
*33 TSL control of user paper (tray) *35 TSL control of user paper (by-pass feed)
This SW is used to set the TSL control which When selecting the by-pass tray on the copy
I ADJUSTMENT
is applicable when the specified paper is basic screen, this SW is used to set the TSL
selected in the Paper type setting in the key control which is applicable when selecting the
operator mode. user paper for Special paper setting or the
When this SW is used to select the Switched specified paper for Paper type setting in the
according to the environment, the switching key operator mode.
is made between Normal control and All off When this SW is used to select the Switched
according to the environment. according to the environment, the switching
Switched according to the environment per- is made between Normal control and All off
forms the TSL control according to the humidity according to the environment.
detected by the main body HUM1 (Humidity sen- Switched according to the environment per-
sor). forms the TSL controle according to the humidity
detected by the main body HUM1 (Humidity sen-
Mode 29-4 29-3
sor).
Normal control 0 0
All off 0 1 Mode 30-4 30-3
Switched according to 1 0 Normal control 0 0
the environment All off 0 1
Switched according to 1 0
the environment
*34 Selection of the transfer/separation output of
user paper (by-pass feed)
When selecting the by-pass tray on the copy *36 Automatic power on by the RADF operation
basic screen, this SW is used to set the trans- during the power save mode
fer/separation output which is applicable when In this setting, when the following operation is
selecting the user specified paper for Special made during the power save mode, the power
paper setting or the specified paper for is automatically turned on.
Paper type setting in the key operator mode. When the original is set in RADF (when the
PS301 (No original sensor) is turned off).
Mode 30-2 30-1 30-0
When the platen/RADF is opened (when PS15
Plain paper (Japan) 0 0 0
(APS timing sensor) is turned off).
Plain paper (Inch) 0 0 1
When the platen/RADF is closed (when PS15
Plain paper (Metric) 0 1 0
(APS timing sensor) is turned on).
Thick paper 0 1 1
Thin paper 1 0 0 Mode 31-0
Recycled paper 1 0 1 Disabled 0
Enabled 1
3 1-28
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 25 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
4mm. This dipswitch is to adjust that shift.
1-29 3
25 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
This function resets the PM count and sets the PM ing the [SET] key, the PM count start date is not
cycle. Care should be taken to reset the PM count changed. It is necessary to reset the count again
properly. The PM count/cycle menu includes the fol- for inputting the count.
lowing:
[1. PM count resetting] 7.3.3 Setting of PM cycle
[2. PM cycle setting]
[3. Counter clear] Set PM Cycle as follows:
3 1-30
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 25 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
4. Counter clear screen (1) Procedure
Press the key corresponding to the item to be 1. Enter the 25 Mode.
cleared. 2. 25 mode menu screen
5. Message in the message display area will con- Press the [Data collection] key.
firm if you really want to clear the item. Press 3. Data collection menu screen
the [YES] key. When the item is cleared, the Press the [Count data] key.
Counter clear screen will be restored. 4. Data collection screen
6. When clearing another counter, repeat above Change the data number with the arrow key.
steps 3 and 4. Pressing [NEXT] key enables display of next
7. Press the [RETURN] key twice to return to the data collection screen.
25 mode menu screen. 5. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the data
collection menu screen.
7.4 Data collection The data is displayed at the line 2 in the mes-
sage display area as Data number (No.): Count
value (00000000).
Press and hold the arrow key to display the next
This function enables viewing of the various data items continuously.
recorded in the machine. Also, it is possible for the
collected data to be checked by KRDS and man- Note:
agement listing. The data collection menu includes In order to check the collected data 2 to 4, be
the following: sure to make preparations given in Collected
Count data collection data list in advance.
Area data collection start (Date count data)
Note:
When the DIPSW8-7 is set to 0, the checking of
the collected data is limited only to No. 1.
1-31 3
25 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
1-32
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 25 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
No. Jam Point KRDS (J0) 45 72-19 FS-112 2D
00 10-0 By-pass 00 46 72-21 FS-112/113 2E
01 11-0 Upper tray 01 47 72-23 FS-112 2F
02 12-0 Lower tray 02 48 72-81 FS-112/113 30
03 13-0 DB upper tray 03 49 72-82 FS-113 31
04 14-0 DB lower tray 04 50 72-83 32
05 16-1 Paper feed jam 05 51 72-25 FS-114 33
06 15-0 LT tray 06 52 72-43 34
07 16-2 LT tray 07 53 72-84 35
08 08 54 72-85 36
09 30-0 Conveyance jam 09 55 37
10 31-0 Conveyance jam 0A :
11 0B 79 4F
12 0C 80 50
13 32-0 Fixing unit conveyance jam 0D Maximum count number : 999,999
14 0E
15 0F (3) Data collection 3
16 75-10 IT-101 10 a. Copy count of each mode
17 75-11 11
No. Contents KRDS (F1)
18 12
00 Platen single side single side 00
19 97-1 ADU conveyance jam 13
01 01
20 97-2 14
02 RADF double side single side 02
21 92-0 15
03 RADF double side double side 03
22 75-12 IT-101 16
04 RADF single side single side 04
23 75-13 17
05 RADF single side double side 05
24 61-1 DF-318/320 18
06 Finisher (Staple mode) 06
25 61-2 19
07 Finisher (Sort mode) 07
26 1A
08 Finisher (Group mode) 08
27 62-1 DF-318/320 1B
09 Finisher (Number of stapling) 09
28 62-2 1C
10 Life-size 0A
29 62-3 1D
11 Fixed ratio E3(1.41/2.00) 0B
30 62-4 1E
12 Fixed ratio E2(1.22/1.55) 0C
31 62-5 1F
13 Fixed ratio E1(1.15/1.29) 0D
32 20
14 Fixed ratio R1(0.86/0.77) 0E
33 63-1 DF-318/320 21
15 Fixed ratio R2(0.82/0.65) 0F
34 63-2 22
16 Fixed ratio R3(0.71/0.50) 10
35 63-3 23
17 User set magnification 11
36 63-4 24
18 Zoom 12
37 25
19 Maximum zoom 13
38 26
20 Minimum zoom 14
39 27
21 AMS mode 15
40 28
22 APS mode 16
41 29
23 AE mode 17
42 72-16 FS-112/113 2A
24 Interrupt mode 18
43 72-17 2B
1-33 3
25 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
3 1-34
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 25 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
No. Error code Classification KRDS Main code Sub code
(decimal number) 043 E56-1 Image control E1 00
Main code Sub code 044 E56-2 communication error 01
001 10-1 Communication error E0 00 045 E56-3 02
002 10-2 01 046 E56-4 03
003 02 047 E56-5 04
004 18-1 Paper feed tray error 03 048 E56-6 Operation control 05
005 18-2 04 049 E56-7 section system error 06
006 18-3 05 050 E56-8 07
007 18-4 06 051 E56-9 08
008 26-1 L detection error 07 052 E56-10 09
009 28-1 High voltage power 08 053 E0 2A
010 28-2 error 09 054 60-1 RADF error 2B
011 28-3 0A 055 60-9 2C
012 34-1 High fixing temperature 0B 056 60-11 2D
013 34-2 abnormality 0C 057 67-3 2E
014 35-1 Low fixing tempera- 0D 058 70-1 Finisher error 2F
015 35-2 ture abnormality 0E 059 70-9 30
016 35-3 0F 060 70-11 31
017 35-4 10 061 77-2 32
018 35-5 11 062 77-3 33
019 35-6 Low fixing tempera- E0 12 063 77-5 Finisher error E0 34
020 35-7 ture abnormality 13 064 77-6 35
021 35-8 14 065 77-11 36
022 35-9 15 066 77-16 37
023 35-10 16 067 80-1 Parameter memory 38
024 36-1 Fixing sensor error 17 068 80-2 board abnormality 39
025 36-2 18 069 80-3 3A
026 36-3 19 070 80-4 3B
027 1A 071 80-5 3C
028 40-1 Scanning system 1B 072 81-1 Flash ROM error 3D
029 40-9 error 1C 073 81-2 3E
030 41-1 1D 074 81-3 3F
031 46-1 Image processing 1E 075 E88-1 Image processing E1 0A
032 46-8 system error 1F system error
033 46-10 20 076 E89-1 System control board 0B
034 46-11 21 077 E89-2 communication error 0C
035 22 078 E89-3 0D
036 49-4 Image processing 23 079 E89-4 0E
037 49-6 system error 24 080 E89-5 0F
038 51-4 Motor speed error 25 081 E89-6 10
039 51-5 26 082 E87-1 Print controller error 11
040 51-6 27 083 52-5 Fan lock error E0 40
041 52-1 Fan lock error 28 084 86-2 Fax board error 41
042 52-2 29 085 86-3 42
1-35 3
25 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
No. Error code Classification KRDS No. Error code Classification KRDS
(decimal number) (decimal number)
I ADJUSTMENT
3 1-36
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 25 MODE
D. Starting periodic date collection 7.5 Copy count for each part to
Reset the periodic data from the setting peri- be replaced
I ADJUSTMENT
odic collection start date. Make a date that this
operation is performed as a new periodic col- Perform the copy count display, count clear, limit
lection start date. value setting and arbitrarily parts to be replaced set-
The periodic data can be checked with the ting to the data of the parts to be replaced (fixed/
KRDS/RDmode (7145) and management list. arbitrarily).
Each count value can be check with the manage-
(1) Procedure ment list of 36 Mode and the KRDS/RDmode
1. Enter the 25 mode. (7145). The following are included in the part
2. 25 mode menu screen counter menu:
Press the [3. Collecting data] key. Copy Count for each fixed replacement part
3. Data collection menu screen Copy Count for each arbitrarily replacement part
Press the [2. Starting periodic data collection]
key. 7.5.1 Copy count by parts to be replaced (fixed)
4. Starting periodic data collection screen
Press the [YES] key to start the periodic data Set the parts name of the fixed parts to be replaced
collection. (fixed), parts No. and copy count display, and count
Press the [NO] or [RETURN] key, then data col- reset.
lection start date is not reset and returns to the
data colleciton menu screen. A. Procedure
1. Enter the 25 Mode.
2. 25 mode menu screen
Press the [4. Parts counter] key.
3. Parts counter menu screen
Press the [1. Count of parts (Fixed)] key.
4. Copy count screen by parts to be replaced
(fixed)
Press the arrow keys to select the data.
5. Press the [Count reset] key.
6. Count reset screen by parts to be replaced
(fixed)
Press the [YES] key to clear the copy count.
Press the [NO] or [RETURN] key, then the copy
count is not reset and returns to the copy count
screen by parts to be replaced.
1-37 3
25 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
3 1-38
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 25 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
(G0)
Set the limit value for the parts to be replaced, parts 00 When copy count (at the paper exit is completed) 00
No., parts name setting, copy count display and 01 When copy count (at the paper exit is completed) 01
count reset.
02 When copy count (at the paper exit is completed) 02
03 When copy count (at the paper exit is completed) 03
A. Copy count display and count reset by parts
04 When copy count (at the paper exit is completed) 04
to be replaced
05 When copy count (at the paper exit is completed) 05
(1) Procedure
06 When copy count (at the paper exit is completed) 06
1. Enter the 25 Mode.
07 When copy count (at the paper exit is completed) 07
2. 25 mode menu screen
08 When copy count (at the paper exit is completed) 08
Press the [4. Parts counter ] key.
09 When copy count (at the paper exit is completed) 09
3. Parts counter menu screen
10 When copy count (at the paper exit is completed) 0A
Press the [2. Count of parts (Named)] key.
11 When copy count (at the paper exit is completed) 0B
4. Copy count screen by parts to be replaced
12 When copy count (at the paper exit is completed) 0C
(named)
13 When copy count (at the paper exit is completed) 0D
Press the arrow key to select the data to be set
14 When copy count (at the paper exit is completed) 0E
or changed.
15 When copy count (at the paper exit is completed) 0F
5. The following items can be set below:
16 When copy count (at the paper exit is completed) 10
COUNT RESET : To clear the copy count.
17 When copy count (at the paper exit is completed) 11
LIMIT SET : To enter the limit value (6-digit).
18 When copy count (at the paper exit is completed) 12
P/N SET : To enter the parts number (9-digit).
19 When paper is fed from LT-203 13
Parts name : To enter the parts name.
20 When paper is fed from by-pass tray 14
6. Press the [RETURN] key, then return to the
21 When paper is fed from tray 1 15
Copy screen by parts to be replaced.
22 When paper is fed from tray 2 16
23 When paper is fed from tray 3 17
24 When paper is fed from tray 4 18
25 When paper is fed from ADU 19
26 When paper is exited from main body 1A
27 When RADF is read (1 count each for front and back) 1B
28 When RADF is read (1 count each for front and back) 1C
29 When RADF is read (1 count each for front and back) 1D
1-39
25 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
1. Enter the 25 Mode. ing the [SET] key, the setting is complete without
2. 25 mode menu screen changing a new limit value and returns to the
Press the [4. Parts counter ] key. copy count screen by parts to be replaced
3. Parts counter menu screen (Named).
Press the [2. Count of parts (Named)] key.
4. Copy count screen by parts to be replaced Reference:
(named) The right side of the limit value will be marked
Press the arrow keys to select the data. if the copy count exceeds its limit value.
5. Press the [COUNT RESET] key.
6. Count reset screen by parts to be replaced E. Parts No. setting
(named) Enter the new parts No. (9-digit) from the
Press the [YES] key to clear the copy count that numeric keys and alphabet keys on the screen.
has been selected.
Press the [NO] or [RETURN] key, then the copy (1) Procedure
count is not reset and returns to the Copy count 1. Enter the 25 Mode.
screen by parts to be replaced (named). 2. 25 mode menu screen
Press the [4. Parts counter ] key.
D. Count limit setting method 3. Parts counter menu screen
Enter the new limit value from the numeric keys Press the [2. Count of parts (Named)] key.
on the screen. 4. Copy count screen by parts to be replaced
(named)
(1) Procedure Press the arrow key to select the data to be set
1. Enter the 25 Mode. or changed.
2. 25 mode menu screen 5. Press the [P/N SET] key.
Press the [4. Parts counter ] key. 6. Part No. setting screen by parts to be replaced
3. Parts counter menu screen (named)
Press the [2. Count of parts (Named)] key. Enter new parts No. using the numeric and
4. Copy count screen by parts to be replaced alphabet keys.
(named) 7. Press the [SET] key to enter the limit value that
Press the arrow key to select the data to be set has been entered.
or changed. 8. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the copy
5. Press the [LIMIT SET] key. count screen by parts to be replaced (named).
6. Copy count limit setting screen by parts to be
replaced (named) Note:
Enter new value using the numeric keys. When pressing the [RETURN] key without press-
7. Press the [SET] key to enter the limit value that ing the [SET] key, the setting is complete without
has been entered. changing a new parts No. and returns to the copy
8. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the copy count screen by parts to be replaced (Named).
count screen by parts to be replaced (named).
1-40
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 25 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
screen. The following passwords are set.
There are three screen in the input screen and Key operator password (8-digits): Password to
are changed with the arrow key: enter key operator mode when security
Alphabet (a capital letter), numeric number enhancement is enabled.
Alphabet (a small letter), numeric number User account (EKC) master key code (8 digits):
Symbol, numeric number An EKC master key code that is required when
The key arrangement can be changed by press- entering various EKC setting modes.
ing the [Keyboard] key in the alphanumeric Weekly timer password (4 digits): A weekly timer
(uppercase letter /lowercase letter), symbol and password that is required when entering various
data input screen. weekly timer setting modes.
CE password (8-digits): Password for CE to
(1) Procedure access service modes when security enhance-
1. Enter the 25 Mode. ment is enabled.
2. 25 mode menu screen
Press the [4. Parts counter ] key. A. Procedure
3. Parts counter menu screen 1. Enter the 25 Mode.
Press the [2. Count of parts (Named)] key. 2. Press the [5. Password setting] key.
4. Copy count screen by parts to be replaced 3. Password setting menu screen
(named) Press the key of an item that you want to set.
Press the arrow key to select the data to be set [Key Operator Password (8 digits)]
or changed. [User account (EKC) master key code (8 digits)]
5. Press the [P/N SET] key. [Weekly timer Password (4 digits)]
6. Parts name setting screen by parts to be [CE Password (8 digits)]
replaced (named) 4. Input a new password through the numeric keys
Enter new parts name using the keys on the and press the [SET] key to update the pass-
screen. word.
7. Press the [OK] key to enter the parts name that When the following keys are set for the pass-
has been entered and return to the copy count word, each mode can be used without a pass-
screen by parts to be replaced (Named). word.
Note:
When pressing the [RETURN] key without press-
ing the [SET] key, the setting is complete. How-
ever the new password will not be entered and
the password setting menu screen will return.
Do not use name, your birthday or employee
code number as the password since other people
can easily guess them.
1-41 3
25 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
The administrator should not inform other people 7.8 Setting the serial number/the
of the password. destination
I ADJUSTMENT
7.7 Setting phone number of the 7.8.1 Setting the serial number
service center
This function is used to display, set and change the
This function displays the telephone and fax num- serial number of the main body and optional units.
bers (Max. 21 digits) of the service center which is The serial numbers can be read from KRDS/
indicated on the screen if a service call is required. RDmode (7145).
This function is not related to KRDS/RDmode
(7145) functions. It is designed only for indicating A. Procedure
the data on the screen. 1. Enter the 25 Mode.
2. 25 mode menu screen
A. Procedure Press the [7. Serial number] key.
1. Enter the 25 Mode. 3. Serial number setting menu screen
2. 25 mode menu screen From among the keys, press the key of an item
Press the [6. Service TEL No.] key. you want to change.
3. Service center number setting screen 4. Serial number setting screen
Press either of the [TEL] or [FAX] key which you Enter the 9-digit serial number from the alpha-
want to set. bet and numeric keys on the screen and then
4. Input the telephone number or fax number press the [SET] key to enter the number that
through the numeric keys and press the [SET] has been entered.
key to update the telephone number or fax num-
ber. Reference:
5. When setting both the telephone number and Characters input are entered at the least signifi-
the fax number, repeat the procedures 3 and 4 cant digit and displayed while shifting from right to
above. left.
6. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the 25
mode menu screen. 5. Repeat the procedures 3 and 4 to set the serial
numbers of other items.
Note: 6. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the Serial
When pressing the [RETURN] key without press- number setting menu screen.
ing the [SET] key, the setting is complete. How-
ever the new phone number will not be entered Note:
and the 25 mode menu screen will return. When pressing the [RETURN] key without press-
ing the [SET] key, the setting is complete. How-
ever the new serial number will not be entered
and the Serial number setting menu screen will
return.
3 1-42
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 25 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
To change the destination setting, press the [Desti- Display ROM version mounted to the machine.
nation] key on the serial-number setup menu. The
procedure is as follows. A. Procedure
1. Enter the 25 Mode.
A. Procedure 2. 25 mode menu screen
1. Enter the 25 Mode. Press the [ROM version] key.
2. 25 mode menu screen 3. ROM version display screen
Press the [7. Serial No.] key. System control
3. Serial number setting screen Image control
Press the [Destination] key. Panel control
4. Destination setting screen Optical control
Use the arrow key to select the destination. Various options
5. Press the [OK] key to register the setting. If any option is not installed, its relevant position
remains blank.
Note: 4. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the 25
If you press [CANCEL] key, the copier will retain mode menu screen.
the previous destination setting and return you to
the Serial number setting screen. 7.10 KRDS setting
6. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the 25 See the Manual for KRDS.
mode menu screen.
7.11 ISW setting
Destination codes
See the chapter ISW.
Code Destination Code Destination
JP Japan IE Ireland
CA Canada FI Finland 7.12 Root counter display
US U.S.A SE Sweden
The root counter (total counter can be checked in
KR Korea NO Norway
25 mode on the root counter display.
SG Singapore AT Austria
MY Malaysia BE Belgium
A. Procedure
CN China NL Netherlands
1. Enter the 25 Mode.
SA Saudi Arabia CH Switzerland
2. 25 mode menu screen
TW Taiwan FR France
Press the [11. Root counter] key.
ZA South Africa GB Great Britain
3. Root counter display screen
PL Poland DE German
Values of the root counter (total counter) are dis-
PT Portugal EU Europe
played.
ES Spain NZ New Zealand
4. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the 25
IT Italy AU Australia
mode screen.
DK Denmark
1-43
25 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
Set the total count start day. This setting is made when changing the paper size
of the option tray (LT-203). The paper size that can
A. Procedure be selected is only A4 and 8.5 x 11.
1. Enter the 25 Mode.
2. 25 mode menu screen A. Procedure
Press the [12.Setting date] key. 1. Enter the 25 mode.
3. Setting date screen 2. 25 mode menu screen
Using the numeric keys, enter the year, month Press the [13. Tray size setting] key.
and day in that sequence. 3. Tray size setting screen
4. Press the [OK] key to return to the 25 mode Press the arrow key to change the paper size of
screen. the LT-203.
4. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the 25
Note: mode menu screen.
Ends when the [CANCEL] key is pressed without
amending the entered date, and returns to the 25
mode menu screen.
1-44
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 36 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
8.1 Setting method L detection adjustment
Automatic toner supply
A special operating mode called 36 Mode has Toner density adjustment
been provided with this machine. This mode Dot diameter adjustment
enables adjustment of the various parts. LD1 offset adjustment
LD2 offset adjustment (7145 only)
A. Procedure LD1 bias adjustment
1. Turn the SW2 (sub power switch) OFF when the LD2 bias adjustment (7145 only)
SW1 (main power switch) remains ON. 3. Press the arrow key until the item you want to
2. Turn the SW2 ON while pressing 3 and 6 of the adjust appears. The adjustment screen of the
copy quantity setting buttons. selected item is displayed.
If security enhancement is enabled, the CE 4. Press the [Preceding screen] of each process
password input request screen appears. In put adjustment screen to return to Process adjust-
CE password. ment menu screen.
36 mode menu screen appears. At this moment,
the machine turns to 36 mode and normal copy (1) Process adjustmentCharging voltage value
operation is disabled. adjustment
3. Press the desired item key on the LCD screen. Charging voltage value adjustment is inhibited in
Each setting screen will appear. the field.
4. Enter data in each setting screen. (2) Process adjustmentTransfer current adjust-
5. Press the [RETURN] key to check the data that ment
has been entered. Transfer current adjustment is inhibited in the
6. Turn the SW2 OFF to cancel the 36 mode. field.
7. New data will be effective after restarting. (3) Process adjustmentSeparation (AC) voltage
adjustment
Note: Separation (AC) voltage adjustment is inhibited
If FNS is not installed, the [FNS adj.] key is netted in the field.
and neither key can be selected. (4) Process adjustmentSeparation (DC) voltage
value adjustment
8.2 Process adjustment Separation (DC) voltage value adjustment is
inhibited in the field.
Adjust the L detection, various high voltages, devel- (5) Process adjustmentCharging grid voltage
oper toner density, dot diameter, and the laser off- adjustment
set. Charging grid voltage adjustment is inhibited in
the field.
A. Procedure (6) Process adjustmentDeveloping bias adjust-
1. Select [1. Process adjustment] in the 36 mode ment
menu screen and display the Process adjust- Developing bias adjustment is inhibited in the
ment menu screen. field.
2. The following items are shown on the Process (7) Process adjustmentL detection adjustment
adjustment menu screen. See L detection adjustment.
Charging voltage value adjustment (8) Process adjustmentAutomatic toner supply
Transfer current adjustment Normally carried out automatically, and the pro-
Separation (AC) voltage adjustment cess adjustment - automatic toner supply is not
Separation (DC) voltage value adjustment made in the field.
1-45 3
36 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
(10) Process adjustmentDot diameter adjustment The developer toner density can be increased or
See Dot diameter adjustment. decreased by making this adjustment.
(11) Process adjustmentLD1 offset adjustment Major cases in which this adjustment is used:
See LD1 offset adjustment. When the image fogging has occurred due to the
(12) Process adjustmentLD2 offset adjustment increased density in the developer toner density.
(7145 only) (In this case, reduce the toner density.)
See LD2 offset adjustment. Preparation: The drum cartridge must be set in
(13) Process adjustmentLD1 bias adjustment advance.
The LD1 bias adjustment is not made in the field.
(14) Process adjustmentLD2 bias adjustment A. Procedure
(7145 only) 1. Enter the 36 mode.
The LD2 bias adjustment is not made in the field. 2. 36 mode menu screen
Press the [1. Process adjustment] key.
8.3 L detection adjustment 3. Press the arrow key repeatedly until the Toner
density adjustment is displayed in the message
This adjustment be made immediately after replace- column.
ment of the developer (before any copies are made 4. Toner density adjustment screen
with the new developer). Developing counter is Select the set value [-2] to [+2], and press the
automatically reset. [START] key.
Set value: -2 (toner density decreased) to +2
Note: (toner density increased)
After replacing the developer, do not make copies When [Current set value] [New set value] =
until you have performed L detection adjustment. the same, return the toner density to the normal
level.
A. Procedure When [Current set value] [New set value] = +
1. Enter the 36 mode. (plus), increase the transient level of the toner
2. 36 mode menu screen density.
Press the [1. Process adjustment] key. When [Current set value] [New set value] = -
3. Process adjustment screen (minus), decrease the transient level of the toner
Press the arrow key until the L detection adjust- density.
ment value. appears in the message display area. According to the value set, the toner density is
4. L detection adjustment screen automatically adjusted. When the adjustment is
Press the [START] key, then confirm that [OK] is terminated in about 250 seconds.
displayed at Result and the L detection data value. 5. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the 36
5. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the 36 mode menu screen.
mode menu screen.
Note:
Note: When an error code is displayed while in the
If an OK indication does not appear after the toner density adjustment, conduct the toner den-
developer has been agitated, it means that an L sity adjustment again after checking the expected
detection adjustment error has occurred. In this defective parts on the error code list.
case, an error code will appear in the Result dis- F26-3: TDS (Toner density sensor output abnor-
play area. For the meaning of error codes, refer to mality)
the L detection error code list of List of error
codes.
3 1-46
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 36 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
The MPC value can be corrected to change the 2. 36 mode menu screen
image density (dot diameter) by entering a setting. Press the [1. Process adjustment] key.
(Common to copier/printer/fax) 3. Press the arrow key repeatedly until the LD1
Major cases in which this adjustment is used: offset adjustment is displayed in the message
When you want to change the image density. column.
When changing the write unit or TCSB (toner 4. LD1 offset adjustment screen
control sensor board), or when cleaning the Press the [COPY] key.
dust-proof glass. 5. Select A3 or 11 x 17 size paper, then press the
Preparation: The drum cartridge must be set in START button to print the test pattern.
advance. 6. Check the test pattern.
Specification: Check to see if the LD1 laser out-
A. Procedure put patterns are uniform as shown in the draw-
1. Enter the 36 mode. ing below and the starting points of the low
2. 36 mode menu screen density section are matched between the refer-
Press the [1. Process adjustment] key. ence lines.
3. Press the arrow key repeatedly until the Dot * Since a single beam is employed for 7235/
diameter adjustment is displayed in the mes- 7228/7222, the pattern shown as LD2 in the
sage column. illustration below is also output by LD1.
4. Dot diameter adjustment screen
Select the set value [-3] to [+3], and press the
[START] key.
According to the value set, the dot diameter is
automatically adjusted. [1]
Set value: -3 (toward the lighter) to +3 (toward
the darker)
5. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the 36
mode menu screen.
Note:
When the adjustment is made toward the darker,
the dot diameter becomes thick and the toner
consumption is increased.
8.6 LD1 offset adjustment LD1 LD2 LD1 LD2 LD1 LD2 LD1 LD2
1-47 3
36 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
A. Procedure
1. Enter the 36 mode.
[1] Reference line
2. 36 mode menu screen
Press the [1. Process adjustment] key.
3. Press the [Next item] key repeatedly until the 7. If it is not within specification, press the # button
LD2 offset adjustment is displayed in the mes- while holding down the button.
sage column. 8. LD2 offset adjustment screen
4. LD2 offset adjustment screen Enter the offset value through the numeric keys
Press the [COPY] key. and press the [SET] key.
5. Select A3 or 11 x 17 size paper, then press the Setting range: -128 ~ +127
START button to print the test pattern. 9. Repeat the procedures 4 to 7 until the specified
6. Check the test patterns. value is attained.
Specification: Check to see if the LD2 laser out- 10. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the 36
put patterns are uniform as shown in the draw- mode menu screen.
ing below and the starting points of the low
density section are matched between the refer-
ence lines.
3 1-48
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 36 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
This function adjusts each timing. When timing Vertical magnification adjustment : RADF (single
adjustment is performed, use A3 or 11 x 17 size side, 50%)
paper. Vertical magnification adjustment : RADF (single
side, 100%)
A. Procedure Vertical magnification adjustment : RADF (single
1. Select [2. Timing adj.] in the 36 mode menu side, 200%)
screen. Vertical magnification adjustment : RADF (single
The Timing adjustment menu screen will side, 400%)
appear. Vertical magnification adjustment : RADF (dou-
The following items are included in the timing ble side, 50%)
adjustment. Vertical magnification adjustment : RADF (dou-
1 Vertical/horizontal magnification adjustment ble side, 100%)
2 Restart timing adjustment Vertical magnification adjustment : RADF (dou-
3 Paper feed loop amount adjustment ble side, 200%)
4 Leading edge original erasure amount adjust- Vertical magnification adjustment : RADF (dou-
ment ble side, 400%)
5 Centering adjustment 4. Enter data from the numeric keys on the screen,
6 Image read point adjustment then press the [SET] key to enter the data that
7 Restoring standard data have been entered.
2. Press the item key to be adjusted. The selected 5. Press the [COPY] key to return to the basic
setting screen will appear. screen, then make a test copy.
3. Press the [RETURN] key in each of the timing 6. Press the # button while pressing the button to
adjustment screens to return to the Timing return to the Vertical/Horizontal magnification
adjustment menu screen. adjustment screen.
7. Press the [RETURN] key in the Vertical and
8.8.1 Vertical/Horizontal magnification adjust- horizontal magnification adjustment screen to
ment return to the Timing adjustment menu screen.
The vertical and horizontal magnifications of the (1) Printer vertical magnification adjustment
printer system and the copy system are adjusted. With the amount of the paper feed loop
adjusted properly between the registration
A. Procedure roller and the fixing roller, the transfer slippage
1. Select [2. Timing adj.] in the 36 mode menu in the position about 20mm from the trailing
screen. edge of the transfer paper is prevented.
The Timing adjustment menu screen will
appear. a. Procedure
2. Select the [1. Drum clock adj.] on the Timing 1. Enter the 36 mode.
adjustment menu screen. 2. 36 mode menu screen
The Drum clock adjustment (vertical/horizontal Press the [2. Timing adj.] key.
magnification adjustment) will appear. 3. Timing adjustment menu screen
3. This adjustment has the following items. These Press the [1. Drum clock adj.] key.
can be selected by pressing the arrow key: 4. Timing adjustment screen
Vertical magnification adjustment : Printer Press the arrow key until Vertical magnification-
Vertical magnification adjustment : Printer 2 printer appears in the message display area.
1-49
36 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
3 1-50
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 36 MODE
11. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the Timing 11. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the Timing
adjustment menu screen. adjustment menu screen.
I ADJUSTMENT
(3) Platen vertical magnification adjustment (4) Platen horizontal magnification adjustment
Adjust the vertical magnification of the scanner Adjust the horizontal magnification of the copy
system. system.
a. Procedure Note:
1. Enter the 36 mode. The result of the platen horizontal magnification
2. 36 mode menu screen will be reflected all the images read by scanner
Press the [2. Timing adj.] key. (RADF, platen).
3. Timing adjustment menu screen
Press the [1. Drum clock adj.] key. a. Procedure
4. Vertical/horizontal magnification (drum clock) 1. Enter the 36 mode.
adjustment screen 2. 36 mode menu screen
Press the arrow key until Vertical magnification- Press the [2. Timing adj.] key.
platen appears in the message display area. 3. Timing adjustment menu screen
5. Press the [COPY] key. Press the [1. Drum clock adj.] key.
6. Basic screen 4. Vertical/horizontal magnification (drum clock)
Set the new test chart on the original glass and adjustment screen
select A3 or 11 x 17 size paper. Then press the Press the arrow key until Horizontal magnifica-
START button. tion-platen appears in the message display
7. Use a ruler to measure the vertical magnifica- area.
tion. 5. Press the [COPY] key.
Standard value: 0.5% max (life size) 6. Basic screen
Within 1mm with respect to 200mm Set the new test chart on the original glass and
select A3 or 11 x 17 size paper. Then press the
START button.
7. Use a ruler to measure the horizontal magnifica-
tion.
Standard value: 0.5% max (life size)
Within 1mm with respect to 200mm
200
1-51
36 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
Setting range: -10 (reduction) ~ +10 (enlarge- 8. If it is not within specification, press the # button
ment) while holding down the button.
I ADJUSTMENT
1-52
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 36 MODE
5. Turn on the Basic Screen by pressing the (2) RADF restart timing adjustment
[COPY] key, then make a test copy from the
I ADJUSTMENT
basic screen. Reference:
6. Press the # button while pressing the button to The operation described here is the same as the
return to the Horizontal/Vertical magnification adjustment in 36 mode menu screen - [9. RADF
adjustment screen. adj.].
7. Press the [RETURN] key in the Restart timing
adjustment screen to return to the Timing a. Procedure
adjustment menu screen. 1. Enter the 36 mode.
2. 36 mode menu screen
(1) Engine restart timing adjustment Press the [2. Timing adj.] key.
3. Timing adjustment menu screen
a. Procedure Press the [2. Restart timing] key.
1. Enter the 36 mode. 4. Restart timing adjustment screen
2. 36 mode menu screen Press the arrow key until the desired RADF
Press the [2. Timing adj.] key. adjustment item appears in the message display
3. Timing adjustment menu screen area.
Press the [2. Restart timing] key. 5. Press the [COPY] key.
4. Restart timing adjustment screen 6. Basic screen
Press the arrow key until the desired adjustment Set the ADF adjustment chart on the RADF and
item appears in the message display area. select A3 or 11 x 17 size paper. Then press the
5. Press the [COPY] key. START button.
6. Basic screen Adjustment the RADF double side (second
Select a maximum paper size for the tray you side), then make a test copy in double side
want to adjust and press START to output the single side mode and check the restart timing of
test pattern. 2nd output paper.
7. Check the restart timing. 7. Check the restart timing.
Standard value: 2.0mm max. Standard value: 3.0mm max. (life size)
8. If it is not within specification, press the # button 8. If it is not within specification, press the # button
while holding down the button. while holding down the button.
9. Restart timing adjustment screen 9. Restart timing adjustment screen
Enter a value from the numeric keys, then press Enter a value from the numeric keys, then press
the [SET] key. the [SET] key.
Setting range: -127 (slow) ~ +127 (fast) Setting range: -50 (slow) ~ +50 (fast)
1 step = 0.1mm 1 step = 0.1mm
10. Repeat steps 5 to 9 until the restart timing 10. Repeat steps 5 to 9 until the restart timing
becomes the standard value. becomes the standard value.
11. To adjust another adjustment item, press the 11. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the timing
arrow key to select the desired adjustment. adjustment menu screen.
12. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the Timing
adjustment menu screen.
1-53 1
36 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
8.8.3 Paper feed loop amount adjustment 6. Press the # button while pressing the button to
return to the Paper feed loop quantity adjust-
I ADJUSTMENT
3 1-54
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 36 MODE
(2) Paper feed loop adjustment for RADF 8.8.4 Leading edge original erasure adjustment
I ADJUSTMENT
Reference: Adjust the leading edge original erasure (leading
The operation described here is the same as the edge blank cut) amount.
adjustment in 36 mode menu screen - [9. RADF
adj.]. Note:
If you reduce the erasure width, a black line may
a. Procedure appear on the leading edge of the paper when
1. Enter the 36 mode. you make an enlarged copy.
2. 36 mode menu screen
Press the [2. Timing adj.] key. A. Procedure
3. Timing adjustment menu screen 1. Enter the 36 mode.
Press the [3. Paper loop adj.] key. 2. 36 mode menu screen
4. Paper feed loop amount adjustment screen Press the [2. Timing adj.] key.
Press the arrow key until RADF appears in the 3. Timing adjustment menu screen
message display area. Press the [4. Lead edge timing] key.
5. Press the [COPY] key. 4. Leading edge original erasure adjustment
6. Basic screen screen
Set the ADF adjustment chart on the RADF and Press the [COPY] key.
select A3 or 11 x 17 size paper. Then press the 5. Basic screen
START button. Place the test chart on the platen glass. Select a
7. Check the condition of skewing in the output maximum paper size for the tray you want to
copy. adjust and press START.
8. When the paper feed loop quantity is not appro- 6. Measure the leading edge original erasure.
priate, press the # button while pressing the Standard value: Within 3.0mm
button. 7. If it is not within specification, press the # button
9. Paper feed loop amount adjustment screen while holding down the button.
Enter a value from the numeric keys, then press 8. Leading edge original erasure adjustment
the [SET] key. screen
Setting range: -10 (small) ~ +10 (large) Enter a value from the numeric keys, then press
1 step = 0.5mm the [SET] key.
10. Repeat steps 5 to 9 until the skewing condition Setting range: -20 (small) ~ +20 (large)
is correct. 1 step = 0.1mm
11. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the Timing 9. Repeat steps 4 to 8 until the leading edge origi-
adjustment menu screen. nal erasure amount becomes the standard
value.
10. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the Timing
adjustment menu screen.
1-55 1
36 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
8.8.5 Centering adjustment 6. Press the # button while pressing the button to
return to the centering adjustment screen.
I ADJUSTMENT
In the centering adjustment, the centering of the 7. Press the [Preceding screen] key in the Center-
image is adjusted in the direction at a right angle to ing adjustment screen to return to the Timing
the feed direction. adjustment menu screen.
1-56
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 36 MODE
(2) ADU centering adjustment 11. To adjust another adjustment item, press the
arrow key to select the desired adjustment.
I ADJUSTMENT
Note: 12. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the Timing
Be sure to perform the centering adjustment for adjustment menu screen.
each tray before starting this adjustment.
(3) Platen centering adjustment
a. Procedure
1. Enter the 36 mode. Note:
2. 36 mode menu screen Be sure to perform the centering adjustment for
Press the [2. Timing adj.] key. each tray before starting this adjustment.
3. Timing adjustment menu screen
Press the [5. Centring adj.] key. a. Procedure
4. Centering adjustment screen 1. Enter the 36 mode.
Press the arrow key until ADU appears in the 2. 36 mode menu screen
message display area. Press the [2. Timing adj.] key.
5. Press the [COPY] key. 3. Timing adjustment menu screen
6. Basic screen Press the [5. Centring adj.] key.
Select copy mode to single side double side 4. Centering adjustment screen
mode, then press the START button to print the Press the arrow key until Platen appears in the
test pattern. message display area.
7. Fold the output at the center in the paper feed 5. Press the [COPY] key.
direction, and check that the left and right lines 6. Basic screen
overlap completely. Set the new test chart on the original glass and
Standard value: Back : Within 3mm select A3 or 11 x 17 size paper, then press the
Front and back : Within 3mm START button.
7. Check the miscentering by comparing the origi-
nal with the copy.
Standard value: Within 2mm
[1] 8. If it is not within specification, press the # button
[2]
while holding down the button.
9. Centering adjustment screen
Enter a value from the numeric keys, then press
the [SET] key.
[1] Lengthwise direction
Setting range: -74 (inward direction of the center
[2] Miscentering amount between first side
line) ~ +74 (rear direction of the center line)
and second side
1 step = 0.04mm
10. Repeat steps 5 to 9 until the miscentering is
8. If it is not within specification, press the # button within standard value.
while holding down the button. 11. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the Timing
9. Centering adjustment screen adjustment menu screen.
Enter a value from the numeric keys, then press
the [SET] key.
Setting range: -53 (inward direction of the center
line) ~ +53 (rear direction of the center line)
1 step = 0.09mm
10. Repeat steps 5 to 9 until the miscentering is
within standard value.
1-57 1
36 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
1 1-58
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 36 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
Reset the adjusted set values of timing adjustment Conduct a test while in continuous copying opera-
to the standard values (factory default data). tion.
The following are included in the return to standard Select the [3. Running mode] in the 36 mode menu
data: screen, then the Running test mode menu screen
Recall standard data : Vertical/Horizontal magni- will appear.
fication adjustment
Recall standard data : Restart timing adjustment The following items can be selected:
Recall standard data : Paper feed loop amount A. Intermittent copy mode
adjustment In this mode, after the set number of copy oper-
Recall standard data : Leading edge original era- ations has been completed, the machine goes
sure adjustment into the copy ready status, waits 0.5 sec., then
Recall standard data : Centering adjustment starts the same operation again.
Recall standard data : Original read point adjust-
ment B. Paperless intermittent copy mode
It makes copies at roughly the same timing as
A. Procedure for a normal copy, without performing paper
1. Enter the 36 mode. detection or jam detection. Also, like running
2. 36 mode menu screen mode 1, after the set number of copy opera-
Press the [2. Timing adj.] key. tions has been completed, the machine goes
3. Timing adjustment menu screen into the copy ready status, waits 0.5 sec., then
Press the [7. Factory default] key. starts the same operation again.
4. Resetting standard data screen
Press the arrow key until the desired item C. Paperless mode
appears in the message display area. It makes copies at roughly the same timing as
5. Press the [YES] key to reset the set values to for a normal copy, without performing paper
the standard values that have been selected detection or jam dection.
and to return to the Timing adjustment menu
screen. Press the [NO] or [RETURN] key, then D. Paperless/endless mode
the set values are not reset and return to the It automatically sets the copy quantity to infinity.
Timing adjustment menu screen. Also, like running mode 3, it makes copies at
6. To reset another adjustment item, repeat steps roughly the same timing as for a normal copy,
4 to 5. without performing paper detection or jam
7. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the Timing detection.
adjustment menu screen.
E. Running mode
Running mode consists of paperless/endless
mode plus an operation consisting of an optics
each-time scan and an automatic paper feed
tray change.
1-59
36 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
3 1-60
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 36 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
No.1 Overall halftone
[Check Items]
When the density is set to 70 (halftone)
When there are white stripes, black stripes or uneven density found, check the printer system for any
abnormality.
[Recommended checkpoints]: Developing unit, and cleaning unit
When the density is set to 0 (white)
When there is image gray back ground, check the printer system for any abnormality.
[Recommended checkpoints]: Charging corona, and high voltage contact
When the density is set at 255 (black)
When the density is thin, check the printer system for any abnormality.
[Recommended check point]: Write unit
* For information about setting the density, see 7.11 Test pattern density adjustment below.
Test Pattern
When the density is set to 70 When the density is set to 0 When the density is set to 255
1-61
36 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
I ADJUSTMENT
[Check Items]
Check the pattern to see if the laser output of LD1/LD2 is uniform with the gradation continuously repro-
duced.
[Recommended checkpoints]: Write unit, and LD1/LD2 offset adjustment
Test Pattern
LD1 LD2
3 1-62
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 36 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
No.11 Beam check
[Check Items 1]
For developement and analysis of the write unit
[Check Items 2]
Check the solid black pattern to see if there is uneven density found in the main scanning and sub-scan-
ning directions.
[Recommended checkpoints]: Charging corona, transfer/separation corona unit, and developing unit
[Check Items 3]
Check to see if there is any image repelling in the gradation pattern at the leading/trailing edge of the
test pattern in the feed direction.
[Recommended checkpoint]: Transfer/separation corona unit
Test Pattern
[1]
[2]
1-63
36 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
I ADJUSTMENT
[Check Items]
Judge from this test pattern which of the scanner system and the printer system is abnormal.
Items that can be checked include horizontal magnification, vartical magnification, tilt image, and lead-
ing edge timing of the printer system. If the copy image is defective despite no abnormality being visible
on the test pattern, the scanner system is defective.
Test Pattern
[1]
31mm 237mm
20mm
[1]
190mm
m
0m
28
205.7mm
28
0m
m
190mm
190mm
1-64
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 36 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
This function adjusts the image quality adjustment.
Density of respective patterns is adjusted in the fol- The following are shown on the image quality
lowing procedure. adjustment menu:
RADF scan density adj.
A. Procedure Non-image area erase check.
1. Enter the 36 mode.
2. 36 mode menu screen 8.12.1 RADF scanning density adjustment
Press the [5. Density adj.] key.
3. Print density adjustment menu screen When the slit glass is replaced, adjust the density
Press the [1. Print density adj. (1)] Key. when reading the original with the RADF.
4. Print density adjustment screen
Press the key according to the desired test pat- Note:
tern to be adjusted. The mechanical adjustment, optical adjustment
5. Enter a desired density by a numeric value from and electrical adjustment of the scanner are com-
the numeric keys, then press the [SET] key. pleted.
Input range : 000 (light) to +255 (dark). Make sure that the slit glass is cleaned.
6. Press the [COPY] key. Make sure that the white chart is not dirty or
7. Basic screen folded.
Press the START button to output a test pattern.
8. Check the density of the output test pattern. A. Procedure
9. Press the # button while pressing the button to 1. Enter the 36 mode.
return to the Print density adjustment screen. 2. 36 mode menu screen
10. To adjust another test pattern, repeat steps 4 to Press the [6. Image quality adj] key.
9. 3. Image quality adjustment screen
11. Press the [RETURN] key to return to Print den- Press the [1. RADF Scan density adj.] key.
sity adjustment menu screen. 4. RADF Scanning density adjustment screen
Set the white chart in A4 direction on the RADF.
5. Press the [START] key.
6. Check that Completed appears in the mes-
sage display area.
7. If ERROR appears in the message display
area, then repeat steps 4 and 5.
Note:
If ERROR is displayed repeatedly, there is a
possibility of a defect in the adjustment of the
scanner machine, optics, or electricrelated parts.
1-65
36 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
(1) Warning-1
Adjust for Extreme Brightness. In many cases, the
Nonimage-area-erase function will not operate cor-
rectly.
Please confirm adjustment - 36 mode columns of
the Service Manual.
(2) Remedy-1
If you use the non-original erasure function, or copy
originals that have a dark background using the
nonoriginal erasure method, relatively infrequently,
use the machine in its present installation environ-
ment.
If, however, you copy originals that have a dark
background fairly frequently, re-install the machine
in a dark location and facing a direction such that
external light does not get into it, then carry out the
installation survey once again.
1-66
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 36 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
Select the [7. List Print] from the 36 mode menu HEX format and the ASCII format. (for analyz-
screen to display the list print menu screen. ing trouble)
You can select following menu options from this Normally not used.
screen.
Test pattern G. Log list (2)
Font pattern The data from the memory is dumped in the
Memory dump list HEX format and the ASCII format. (for analyz-
Management list ing trouble)
Adjustment list Normally not used.
Log list (1)
Log list (2) H. Analysing list
Analysing list Outputs the necessary list prints together if
E-Mail KRDS com.list trouble occurs in the field. (for analysing trou-
ble)
Note: Normally not used.
Don't try to touch a mode not mentioned.
(1) Procedure
A. Test pattern 1. Enter the 36 mode.
This option is used to output a grid pattern con- 2. 36 mode menu screen
sisted of line width of 2 dots and line-to-line Press the [7. List print] key.
space of 500 dots. From this pattern, you can 3. List print menu screen
check the write system for normal performance. Press the key corresponding to the desired
menu option.
B. Font pattern 4. List print screen
This option outputs the font list built in the When outputting the memory dump list, specify
engine. the start and end addresses.
1-67 3
36 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
The counter must be cleared whenever the drum or Adjustments of RADF are performed in the follow-
fixing parts/unit is replaced. ing procedures. For the adjustment, A3 or 11 x 17
Select the [8. Counter Clear] from the 36 mode copy paper should be used.
menu screen to display the counter clear screen.
Following menu options are available from this A. Procedure
screen. 1. Select the [9. RADF adj.] from the 36 mode
Drum related counter (Drum counter, Drum drive menu screen to display the RADF adjustment
counter). menu.
Fixing counter (Fixing web counter). The following are included in the RADF adjust-
ment:
A. Procedure 1 Vertical/horizontal magnification (Drum clock)
1. Enter the 36 mode. adjustment
2. 36 mode menu screen 2 Restart timing adjustment
Press the [8. Counter clear] key. 3 Paper feed loop amount adjustment
3. Counter clear screen 4 Centering adjustment
Press the key corresponding to the item to be 5 RADF scanning density adjustment
cleared. 2. Press the key corresponding to the desired
4. Message in the message display area will con- item. The screen corresponding to the selected
firm if you really want to clear the item. Press item will appear.
the [YES] key. When the item is cleared, the 3. Press the [Preceding screen] key in each of the
Counter clear screen will be restored. RADF adjustment screens to return to the
5. When clearing another counter, repeat above RADF adjustment menu screen.
steps 3 and 4.
6. Press the [RETURN] key to return to 36 mode 8.15.1 Vertical magnification adjustment in
menu screen. RADF system
1-68
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 36 MODE
Vertical magnification adjustment : RADF (dou- Standard value: 0.5% max (life size)
ble side, 50%) Within 1.0mm with respect to 190mm
I ADJUSTMENT
Vertical magnification adjustment : RADF (dou-
ble side, 100%)
Vertical magnification adjustment : RADF (dou-
ble side, 200%)
Vertical magnification adjustment : RADF (dou-
ble side, 400%)
4. Enter a desired value from the numeric keys on
the screen, then press the [SET] key to validate
your entry.
5. Turn on the Basic Screen by pressing the [1]
190
[COPY] key, then make a test copy from the
basic screen.
[1] Vertical magnification
6. Press the # button while depressing the button
to return to the Magnification adjustment
screen. 8. If it is not within specification, press the # button
7. Press the [Preceding screen] key in the Verti- while holding down the button.
cal/horizontal magnification adjustment screen 9. Vertical/Horizontal magnification (drum clock)
to return to the RADF adjustment menu adjustment screen
screen. Enter a value from the numeric keys, then press
the [SET] key.
B. Vertical magnification adjustment in RADF Setting range: -20 (reduction) ~ +20 (enlarge-
system ment)
Adjust the vertical magnification while in RADF 1 step = 0.1%
copying. 10. Repeat steps 5 to 9 until the vertical magnifica-
tion becomes the standard value.
a. Procedure 11. To adjust another adjustment item, press the
1. Enter the 36 mode. arrow key to select the desired adjustment.
2. 36 mode menu screen 12. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the RADF
Press the [9. RADF adj.] key. adjustment menu screen.
3. RADF adjustment menu screen
Press the [1. Drum clock adj.] key. 8.15.2 Adjustment of restart timing
4. Vertical/Horizontal magnification (drum clock)
adjustment screen Use the following procedure to adjust the RADF
Press the arrow key to select the magnification restart timing.
you want to adjust.
The screen changes in the following order: Sin- A. Procedure
gle sided 50% 100% 200% 400% 1. Select the [9. RADF adj.] from the 36 mode
Double sided 50% 100% 200% 400%. menu screen to display the RADF adjustment
5. Press the [COPY] key. menu.
6. Set the ADF adjustment chart on the RADF and 2. Select [2. Restart timing] from the RADF
select A3 or 11 x 17 size paper. Then press the adjustment menu and the Re-start timing
START button. adjustment screen will appear.
7. Use a ruler to measure the vertical magnifica-
tion.
1-69
36 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
3. Using the arrow key will allow you to select the 5. Basic screen
following items. Set the ADF adjustment chart on the RADF and
I ADJUSTMENT
Restart timing adjustment : RADF (single side) select A3 or 11 x 17 size paper. Then press the
Restart timing adjustment : RADF (double side, START button.
front) 6. Check paper feed loop volume.
Restart timing adjustment : RADF (double side, 7. When the paper feed loop quantity is not appro-
back) priate, press the # button while pressing the
4. Enter a desired value from the numeric keys on button.
the screen, then press the [SET] key to validate 8. Paper feed loop amount adjustment screen
your entry. Enter a value from the numeric keys, then press
5. Turn on the Basic Screen by pressing the the [SET] key.
[COPY] key, then make a test copy from the Setting range: -10 (decrease) ~ 00 (standard) ~
basic screen. +10 (increase)
6. Check the restart timing. 1 step = 0.5mm
Standard value: -3.0mm maximum (Life size). 9. Repeat above steps 4 to 8 until an appropriate
7. If it is not within specification, press the # button paper feed loop volume is obtained.
while depressing the button 10. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the RADF
8. Restart timing adjustment screen adjustment menu screen.
Enter the value from the numeric keys, then
press the [SET] key. 8.15.4 Centering adjustment
Setting range: -50 (delays the timing) ~
+50 (advances the timing) Reference:
1 step = 0.1mm The operation described here is the same as the
9. Repeat steps 5 to 9 until the re-start timing adjustment in 36 mode menu screen -[2. Timing
meets the standard value. adjustment].
10. Press the [RETURN] key in the Restart timing
adjustment screen to return to the RADF Adjust the centering of the image in the direction at
adjustment menu screen. a right angle to the original feed direction of the
RADF. For adjustment items, the following three
8.15.3 Paper feed loop adjustment items can be selected:
Centering adjustment : RADF (single side)
Reference: Centering adjustment : RADF (double side, front)
The operation described here is the same as the Centering adjustment : RADF (double side,
adjustment in 36 mode menu screen -[2. Timing back)
adjustment].
A. Procedure
Adjust the paper feed loop quantity while in RADF 1. Enter the 36 mode.
copying. 2. 36 mode menu screen
Press the [9. RADF adj.] key.
A. Procedure 3. RADF adjustment menu screen
1. Enter the 36 mode. Press the [4. Centring adj.] key.
2. 36 mode menu screen 4. Centering adjustment screen
Press the [9. RADF adj.] key. Press the arrow key until the desired item
3. RADF adjustment menu screen appears in the message display area.
Press the [3. Paper Loop adj.] key. 5. Press the [COPY] key.
4. Paper feed loop amount adjustment screen
Press the [COPY] key.
1 1-70
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 36 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
select A3 or 11 x 17 size paper, then press the 7. If the message ERROR appears in the mes-
START button. sage display area, repeat above steps 4 and 5.
When the RADF (double side, back) is selected,
make copies from double side single side Note:
mode, and use the second for the adjustment. If ERROR is displayed repeatedly, there is a
7. Check the miscentering by comparing the origi- possibility of a defect in the adjustment of the
nal with the copy. scanner machine, optics, or electricrelated parts.
Standard value: Within 3mm
8. If it is not within specification, press the # button 8. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the RADF
while holding down the button. adjustment menu screen.
9. Centering adjustment screen
Enter a value from the numeric keys, then press 8.15.6 RADF image read point adjustment
the [SET] key.
Setting range: -74 (inward direction of the center Adjust the original read position while in RADF
line) ~ +74 (rear direction of the center line) copying.
1 step = 0.04mm
10. Repeat steps 5 to 9 until the miscentering is Note:
within standard value. The RADF read position adjustment is inhibited in
11. Press the [RETURN] key to return to the RADF the field.
adjustment menu screen.
8.16 FNS adjustment
8.15.5 RADF scanning density adjustment (FS-112 only)
Whenever the slit glass is replaced, its density in Adjust the alignment plate position of the finisher.
reading an original must be adjusted in the following When the sheets of paper exited from the finisher
manner. are uneven, adjust the corresponding paper size.
Note: A. Procedure
Before starting this operation, every adjustment 1. Enter the 36 mode.
must be completed for the scanner's mechanical, 2. 36 mode menu screen
optical and electric system. Press the [10. FNS adj.] key.
Make sure that the slit glass must be cleaned. 3. FNS adjustment menu screen
Make sure that the white chart is not stained or Press [1. FNS alignment plate position adjust-
folded. ment (rear)] or [2. FNS alignment plate position
adjustment (front)].
A. Procedure 4. FNS matching plate position adjustment
1. Enter the 36 mode. screen
2. 36 mode menu screen Press the arrow key until the target paper size of
Press the [9. RADF adj.] key. the adjustment is displayed.
3. RADF adjustment menu screen 5. Press the [Copy screen] key to display the basic
Press the [5. RADF Scan density adj.] key. screen. Set the output setting to the group mode
4. RADF scanner density adjustment screen and press the [OK] key.
Set the white chart in A4 direction on the RADF. Conduct the test copy on the paper size in
5. Press the [START] key. which irregularity occurs.
1-71
36 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
3 1-72
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 36 MODE
8.17.2 Fold position adjustment (SK-114) 8. If it is not within the standard, press # button
while pressing button.
I ADJUSTMENT
Adjust the fold position of the saddle kit. 9. On the Fold position adj. screen,
It is adjusted when the fold unit is replaced, when enter a numeric value using the numeric key-
the fold position is incorrect, and when the folding pad. Then, press [SET] key.
tilt adjustment is performed. Setting range: -10 ~ +10
1 step = 0.5mm
A. Procedure In case of A: set a plus value
1. Enter the 36 mode. In case of B: set a minus value
2. 36 mode menu screen 10. Repeat the steps 4 through 8 until the fold posi-
Press any key to return again to 36 mode menu tion comes within the standard range.
screen. Only through this operation, [10. FNS 11. Press [RETURN] and go back to the FNS adj.
adj.] is made effective. menu screen.
Press the [10. FNS adj.] key.
3. On the FNS adj. menu screen, 8.17.3 Punch position adjustment (PK-114)
select [2. Fold position adj.].
4. On the Fold position adj. screen, select the Adjust the hole positions of the punch kit.
paper size you want to adjust by using the arrow
keys. A. Procedure
5. Press the [Copy screen] key to output a fold 1. Enter the 36 mode.
sample. 2. 36 mode menu screen
6. Fold the output sample along its crease. Press any key to return again to 36 mode menu
7. Check the misalignment. screen. Only through this operation, [10. FNS
Standard A, B: 0 1.5mm adj.] is made effective.
Press the [10. FNS adj.] key.
3. On the FNS adj. menu screen,
A
select [3. Punch position adj.].
4. Press the [Copy screen] key to output a
punched sample.
5. Check the hole positions on the sample.
Standard A: 13 3mm (2 holes)
9.5 3mm (2 holes and 3 holes)
Exit direction 11 3mm (4 holes)
4511D525AA
A
B
Exit direction
1-73 3
36 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
A. Procedure
1. Enter the 36 mode.
[1] [2] 2. 36 mode menu screen
7145fs1041
Press any key to return again to 36 mode menu
screen. Only through this operation, [10. FNS
adj.] is made effective.
A Press the [10. FNS adj.] key.
3. On the FNS adj. menu screen,
select [4. Punch loop adj.].
4. On the Punch loop adj. screen, select the
paper size you want to adjust by using the arrow
keys.
[1] [2] 5. Press the [Copy screen] key to output a
7145fs1042
punched sample.
6. Check the tilt of holes on the sample.
7. If the holes are tilted, press # button while
A pressing button.
8. On the Punch loop adj. screen,
enter a numeric value using the numeric key-
pad. Then, press [SET] key.
Setting range: -4 ~ +4
1 step = 1.0mm
[1] [2] 7145fs1043
3 1-74
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 36 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
When inclination is in a punch hole: set a plus
value (In both the cases of [1] and [2], it sets to
plus side.)
9. Repeat the steps 4 through 7 until there is no tilt.
10. Press [RETURN] and go back to the FNS adj.
menu screen.
1-75 3
47 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
9. 47 MODE c. Procedure
1. Enter the 47 mode.
I ADJUSTMENT
e. Procedure
1. Enter the 47 mode.
2. 47 mode menu screen
Using the numeric keys, enter the output check
[1] [2] [3] [4]
code.*2
3. When using the multi mode, press the button.
[1] Input/Output check code
4. Using the numeric keys, enter the multi code.*2
[2] Multi code
5. Press the [START] key to perform the output
[3] Input check
check.
[4] Output check
6. To end the output check, press the [STOP] key.
7. To make another output check, repeat steps 2 to
(2) Input check method 6.
a. Using the numeric keys, enter the code *2 See [6] Output check list.
input for the desired signal (sensor, etc.) to
check. (4) Exiting the 47 mode
b. When using the multi mode, press the but- To end the 47 mode, turn the SW2 OFF.
ton and enter the multi code according to
the desired input check item (signal) with
the numeric keys.
2 1-76
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 47 MODE
9.2 RADF original size detection 11. Press the [START] key.
12. To end the output check, press the [STOP] key.
I ADJUSTMENT
This adjustment is done when RADF fails to cor- 13. Set a sheet of B6R paper in the By-pass tray.
rectly detect size of an original. 14. Press the button.
15. Press [3] by means of the numeric keys.
A. Procedure Check that 028-003 appears in the message
1. Enter the 47 mode. display area.
2. 47 mode menu screen 16. Press the [START] key.
Press 69 by means of the numeric keys. 17. Press the [STOP] key.
Check that 069-000 appears in the message 18. To end the 47 mode, turn the SW2 OFF.
display area.
3. Set the original guide plate to the minimum size 9.4 Action for mounting when
(width) position, then press the [START] key. reinstalling the HDD
4. To end the output check, press the [STOP] key.
5. Press the button. Removing the HDD for analysis of an abnormality
6. Enter 1 from the the numeric keys. and then reinstalling it after turning on and off the
Make sure that 069-001 is indicated in the power may result in no recognition of the HDD. To
message display area. avoid a condition like this, conduct this setting.
7. Set the original guide plate to the maximum size
(width) position, then press the [START] key. A. Procedure
8. To end the output check, press the [STOP] key. 1. Enter the 47 mode.
9. To end the 47 mode, turn the SW2 OFF. 2. 47 mode setting screen
Press the No. of sheets setting button to enter
9.3 By-pass size detection 15. Check to see if 015-000 is displayed in
adjustment the message display column.
3. Press the button.
Perform this adjustment if paper size detection at 4. Press the No. of sheets setting button to enter
the by-pass feed tray does not function correctly. 97.
Check to see if 015-097 is displayed in the
A. Procedure message display column.
1. Enter the 47 mode. 5. Press the [START] key.
2. 47 mode menu screen 6. Press the [STOP] key to terminate the setting.
Press 28 by means of the numeric keys. 7. To end the 47 mode, turn the SW2 OFF.
Check that 028-000 appears in the message
display area. Note:
3. Set a sheet of A4R paper in the by-pass tray. When the data is in nonconformity, an error may
4. Press the button. occur. In that case, execute the format (key oper-
5. Press [1] by means of the numeric keys. ator mode).
Check that 028-001 appears in the message
display area.
6. Press the [START] key.
7. Press the [STOP] key.
8. Set a sheet of A4 paper in the by-pass tray.
9. Press the button.
10. Press 2 by means of the numeric keys.
Check that 028-002 appears in the message
display area.
1-77 1
47 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
1-78
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 47 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0
LCT(3) A4 A4R 8.5 x 11 8.5 x 11R B5R B5 A4 A4R 8.5 x 11 8.5 x 11R
*2 The results can be displayed by pressing the start button the stop button in this order.
1-79 3
47 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
ON OFF
Intrinsic 50 1 Check of DB serial communications 0001 0000
functions (7145) Normal Abnormal
Check of DF serial communications or not
(7235/7228/7222) connected
2 Check of FNS serial communications
3 Check of scanner serial communica-
tions
4 Check of Main drive board serial com-
(7235/7228/7222) munications
51 1 Judging of the main body type (7145)
0096 to 0098*3
(7235/7228/7222)
2 Judging of the DB type 0 to 6*4
TLD 57 1 Toner level detector sensor Not Provided
provided
PS5 2 Toner bottle sensor Provided Not
provided
RADF PS301 60 1 No original sensor Paper No paper
PS304 2 Cover open/close sensor Open Close
PS303 3 DF open/close sensor Open Close
PS308 4 Original registration sensor No paper Paper
PS309 5 Original conveyance sensor
PS302 6 Original exit sensor Paper No paper
PS305 7 Original size sensor /1
PS306 8 Original size sensor /2
VR301 9 Original size VR 0 to 255
Display 0 2 3 5 6
Judging type Not connected DB-211 DB-411 DB-211 + LT-203 DB-411 + LT-203
3 1-80
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 47 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
ON OFF
FS-112 PS701 70 1 Pressure sensor (Level) No Pressure
pressure applied
PS705 2 Shutter sensor ON OFF
PS701 3 Pressure sensor (HP) No Pressure
pressure applied
PS704 4 Paper exit full sensor Other Full
than full
PS703 8 Exit sensor Paper No paper
PS702 9 FNS entrance censor
PS712 10 Stapler HP sensor Other H.P.
than H.P.
PS713 12 Staple detection sensor No Staples
staples provided
provided
PS714 14 Stapler ready sensor Stapler Stapler
not ready ready
16 24V detect 0V 24V
PS711 17 Tray upper limit sensor Upper Not at
limit upper
limit
PS706 18 Tray lower limit sensor Lower Other
limit than
lower
limit
PS707 19 No paper sensor Paper No paper
PS708 20 Stapler unit HP sensor H.P. Other
PS709 21 Alignment HP sensor /R than H.P.
PS710 22 Alignment HP sensor /F
FS-113 PC1 70 1 1st tray exit sensor Paper No paper
PC3 2 Stacking sensor
PC4 3 Upper path sensor
PC2 4 Lower path sensor
PC6 5 1st tray full detection sensor
PC7 6 Elevate tray full detection sensor
PC9 7 Alignment HP sensor H.P. Other
PC14 8 Staple home sensor than H.P.
PC12 9 Stacking roller home sensor
PC13 10 Paper exit roller home sensor
PC5 11 Process tray paper detection sensor Paper No paper
12 Stapler 1 home sensor H.P. Other
than H.P.
1-81
47 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
1 1-82
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 47 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
FS-114 PC16-FN 70 15 Shutter home position sensor Home Except home
PC11-FN 17 Exit paddle home position sensor position position
PC12-FN 18 Exit roller home position sensor
PC8-FN 19 Storage tray paper detect sensor Paper exists No paper
PC10-FN 20 Staple home position sensor Shade Transmit
21 Self-priming sensor
22 Staple empty detection sensor
23 Staple home sensor
25 Punch position sensor 1 Transmit Shade
26 Punch position sensor 2
PC1-PK 27 Punch trash full sensor Shade Transmit
PC22-SK 28 Crease roller home position sensor Home Except home
position position
S4-FN 29 Transport jam detection SW Close Open
PC26-SK 30 Layable guide home sensor Shade Transmit
PC20-SK 31 Saddle exit sensor Paper exists No paper
PC21-SK 32 Saddle tray empty sensor
33 Saddle staple home position sensor 1 Shade Transmit
34 Saddle self-priming sensor 1
35 Saddle staple empty detection sensor 1
36 Saddle staple home position sensor 2
37 Saddle self priming sensor 2
38 Saddle staple empty detection sensor 2
S4-SK 39 Saddle interlock switch Open Close
PC18-SK 40 Saddle exit roller home position sensor Except home Home
position position
ADU PS4 80 ADU sensor Open Close
1-83
47 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
3 1-84
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 47 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
High volt- PRMB 15 98 Initialize KRDS non volatile area
age/image 99 Initial generation of document folder
Paper feed SD1 20 1 1st paper feed solenoid /U
SD2 2 1st paper feed solenoid /L
SD3 3 By-pass solenoid
SD101 4 Paper feed solenoid /U
SD102 5 Paper feed solenoid /L
SD151 6 LT Paper feed solenoid
M9 21 1 Paper feed motor
M100 2 DB Paper feed motor
M150 3 LT Paper feed motor
M9, MC1, 4 Paper feed motor, registration clutch,
MC2 loop clutch
M7 23 1 Tray motor /U
M8 2 Tray motor /L
M101 3 Tray up motor /3
M102 4 Tray up motor /4
M151 5 Tray up motor
MC1 25 Registration clutch
MC2 26 Loop clutch
28 1 By-pass size adjustment (A4R in width)
2 By-pass size adjustment (A4 in width)
3 By-pass size adjustment (B6R in width)
SD7 29 Separation claw solenoid
Scanner M2 31 1 Scanner motor
M5, FM7 32 1 Polygon motor (steady rotation) *1
(7235)
M5, FM7 2 Polygon motor (Pre-rotation) *1
(7235)
M2,L1 34 Shading correction operation
LD 36 Laser PWM (0 to 255)
LD,M5 37 Conpel to laser ON
LD,M5 38 LD alarm measurement
L1 39 Platen still APS
Main body M11 40 Fixing motor
M1 41 1 Main motor (sequential)
M1 2 Main motor (motor alone)
FM3 42 1 Internal dehumidifying fan /1
FM4 2 Internal cooling fan /1
*1 7235 only, FM7 (Polygon cooling fan) also rotates at the same time.
1-85 3
47 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
3 1-86
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 47 MODE
I ADJUSTMENT
FS-112 M701 70 1 FNS conveyance motor
M702 2 Paper exit motor (forward rotation)
M702 3 Paper exit motor (reverse rotation)
M707 4 Pressure motor (forward rotation)
M707 5 Pressure motor (reverse rotation)
M706 6 Tray up motor(raise)
M706 7 Tray up motor (lower)
M705 8 Stapler shift motor, (initialize) (A4/F)
M705 9 Stapler shift motor, (initialize)(A4/R)
M703,M704 10 Alignment motor /R,F (initialize)
M703,M704 11 Alignment motor /R,F (A4 size position)
M703,M704 12 Alignment motor /R,F (rocking)
M708 13 Stapler motor
FS-114 M1-FN 70 1 Exit motor
M2-FN Transport motor
M3-FN Entrance motor
M4-FN 3 Alignment motor 1
M5-FN Alignment motor 2
M11-FN 5 Elevator motor (up)
M11-FN 6 Elevator motor (down)
M12-FN 7 Shutter opening motor
M6-FN 11 Exit open/close motor
M9-SK 12 Saddle exit open/close motor
M7-FN 17 Stapling unit moving motor
M10-SK 23 Crease motor
SL1-FN 53 Storage paddle solenoid
SL2-FN 54 Exit paddle solenoid
78 Punch motor
79 Punch motor
IT SD8 75 1 IT gate solenoid
ADU M6 80 1 Forward rotation (7145: 230mm/sec,
7235: 180mm/sec, 7228/7222: 140mm/
sec)
M6 2 Forward rotation (600mm/sec)
M6 3 Reverse rotation (7145: 230mm/sec,
7235: 180mm/sec, 7228/7222: 140mm/
sec)
M6 4 Reverse rotation (600mm/sec)
SD5 83 ADU gate solenoid
1-87 3
47 MODE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
3 1-88
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 OTHER ADJUSTMENTS
I ADJUSTMENT
Caution:
Be sure the power cord has been unplugged
from the wall outlet.
1-89
OTHER ADJUSTMENTS 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
A. Procedure
1. Set a A3 paper on the tray of the main body.
2. Set the ADF adjustment chart on the RADF,
then make a copy.
3. Check the amount of distortion in the copy.
Standard value: 0.3% less.
[1]
A B
1-90
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 OTHER ADJUSTMENTS
I ADJUSTMENT
When the front side of the originals are fed being
skewed, adjust the registration pully bracket.
A. Procedure
1. In the single sided single sided copy mode,
set the adjustment chart to the RADF for copy-
ing.
2. Check the original skew pattern.
Standard value: Within 0.5%
[1]
[3]
[2] A B
[1] Image
[2] Paper
[3] Paper feed direction
[2]
1-91
OTHER ADJUSTMENTS 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
A. Procedure
1. In the double sided single sided copy mode,
set the adjustment chart to the RADF for copy-
ing.
2. Check the original skew pattern.
Standard value: Within 0.5%
[1]
[3]
[2] A B
[1] Image
[2] Paper
[3] Paper feed direction
1-92
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 OTHER ADJUSTMENTS
I ADJUSTMENT
ers[2].
4. Loosen the hexagon nut[3], and rotate the set
screw[4] to adjust the clearance of the guide
plate.
A: Loosen the hexagon nut[3] at the rear and
rotate the set screw[4] clockwise.
B: Loosen the hexagon nut[3] at the front and
rotate the set screw[4] clockwise.
[2]
Note:
Since there is the possibility of jamming, be sure
not make the clearance of the guide plate nar-
rower than the standard value. (Be sure not to
tighten the hexagon nut [3].)
The reference value of the clearance of the guide
plate should be determined based on the position
where the difference in level[A] of the second
stage of the clearance reference block[5]
becomes flush with the metal frame surface[B].
[4]
1-93
OTHER ADJUSTMENTS 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
A. Procedure
1. Loosen a screw[1] on the side guide situated at
[2]
bottom of the paper feed tray. And also loosen
the 2 screws[3] on the reinforcing plates (front/
[1]
back)[2] situated at top of the tray.
[3]
2. Rotate the adjusting cam[4], move the side
guide back and forth and adjust it so that the
centering of the image center[6] to the paper
center[5] becomes within the specified value
(within 3mm).
3. When the adjustment is complete, tighten the
screws provided for the side guide and reinforc-
ing plates. [4]
Note: [7]
If paper miscentering occurs, move the side guide [6]
forwards and backwards, and adjust the gap for
the paper in use to between 1.0 and 1.5mm. [5]
(The gap must be set so that the tray meets both
the lower limit position and the upper limit posi-
tion.)
1-94
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 OTHER ADJUSTMENTS
I ADJUSTMENT
Normal paper feed can't be expected if the tray is
tilted. In such case, adjust the tray and paper feed
roller shaft so that they may be parallel in each
other. Whenever the wire is replaced, this adjust-
ment must be implemented.
A. Procedure
1. Remove the front cover of the tray.
2. Loosen a screw[2] of the wire adjustment part[1]
situated in front side of the tray.
[1]
[2]
[2]
[4]
1-95
OTHER ADJUSTMENTS 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
A. Procedure
1. Remove the LT from the main body.
2. Open the top cover and remove the right cover
and the front cover.
3. Loosen a screw[2] of the wire adjustment part[1]
situated in front.
[1]
[2]
1-96
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 OTHER ADJUSTMENTS
I ADJUSTMENT
5. Move the wire adjustment part[3] until the dis-
tance from top of the side plate to the tray[1] top
face is equal in both the front and back sides.
6. When the adjustment is complete, tighten the
screw[4] for the wire adjustment part[3].
[2]
[3]
[4]
1-97
OTHER ADJUSTMENTS 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
A. Switches on PWB
S3
S2
S1
1-98
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 OTHER ADJUSTMENTS
B. Test Mode
(1) Test Mode Setting Procedure
I ADJUSTMENT
a. Procedure
1. Turn OFF SW2 (Sub power switch) of the
copier.
2. Flip keys of the DIP switch into the ON or OFF
position as necessary. (See Table below.)
3. Turn ON SW2 (Sub power switch) of the copier.
4. This sets the Finisher into the corresponding
Test Mode operation.
b. Resetting Procedure
Flip all keys of the DIP switch to their respective
initial positions (OFF positions) and turn OFF,
then ON, SW2 (Sub power switch) of the copier.
1-99
OTHER ADJUSTMENTS 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
S1: ON
Motors and solenoids: Energized
[Entrance Motor (M1), Upper Entrance Motor
(M4), Upper/Lower Entrance Switching Sole-
noid (SL1), 1st Tray Entrance Selecting Sole-
noid (SL2)]
S2: ON
Motors and solenoids: Deenergized
[Entrance Motor (M1), Upper Entrance Motor
(M4), Upper/Lower Entrance Switching Sole-
noid (SL1), 1st Tray Entrance Selecting Sole-
noid (SL2)]
S1: ON
Motors: Energized
[Entrance Motor (M1), Upper Entrance Motor
(M4), Lower Entrance Motor (M2), Exit Motor
(M3)]
S2: OFF
Motors: Deenergized
[Entrance Motor (M1), Upper Entrance Motor
(M4), Lower Entrance Motor (M2), Exit Motor
(M3)]
S1: ON
Motors and solenoids: Energized
[Entrance Motor (M1), Upper Entrance Motor
(M4), Lower Entrance Motor (M2), Exit Motor
(M3), Upper/Lower Entrance Switching Sole-
noid (SL1)]
S2: OFF
Motors and solenoids: Deenergized
[Entrance Motor (M1), Upper Entrance Motor
(M4), Lower Entrance Motor (M2), Exit Motor
(M3), Upper/Lower Entrance Switching Sole-
noid (SL1)]
d. Shifting Operation
S1: ON
S2: ON
1-100
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 OTHER ADJUSTMENTS
I ADJUSTMENT
S1: ON
S1: ON
S1: ON
S1: ON
S1: ON
S1: ON
At home position
S1: ON
S1: ON
At home position
S1: ON
S1: ON
Pressed
S2: ON
Separated
S1: ON
Pressed
S2: ON
Separated
1-101
OTHER ADJUSTMENTS 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
S1: ON
Goes up until the Elevator Tray Upper Limit
Sensor PQ
(PWB-D) is blocked.
S2: ON
Goes down until the Elevator Tray Upper Limit
Sensor PQ
(PWB-D) is unblocked.
S1: ON
S1: ON
S2: ON
S1: ON
2-hole position
S2: ON
3-hole position
l. Sensor Test
1-102
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 OTHER ADJUSTMENTS
I ADJUSTMENT
A. Procedure
1. Set the copier into the Hole Punch mode and
make a 1-sided copy from a 1-sided original.
2. Fold the copy in half and check to see if the
holes are aligned
(deviation should be within 2mm).
3. If the holes are misaligned, loosen the screw
that secure the Punch Unit and slide the Punch
Unit as necessary.
4. Make a copy again and check for correct hole
positions.
1-103
OTHER ADJUSTMENTS 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
1-104
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 OTHER ADJUSTMENTS
I ADJUSTMENT
A. Adjustment of the Upper Entrance Motor
(M4) Timing Belt
(1) Procedure
1. Loosen 2 screws.
2. Use a spring balance to apply pressure at C and
tighten the 2 screws at the position where the
tension becomes 200 100gf when the belt
deflects 4mm.
1-105
OTHER ADJUSTMENTS 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
Sensor
This adjustment must be made when the Control
Board (PWB-A) or the Elevate Tray Top Face
Sensor (PWB-C, D) is replaced with a new one.
A. Procedure
1. Set up the sensor test mode.
2. Turn VR1 on PWB-A fully counterclockwise.
3. Using a sheet of paper, block the Elevator Tray
Upper Limit Sensor LED (PWB-C).
4. Check that LED4 on PWB-A turns OFF. If it
stays ON, slowly turn VR1 clockwise and stop
turning it as soon as the LED turns OFF.
1-106
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 OTHER ADJUSTMENTS
I ADJUSTMENT
Level
This adjustment must be made when the Control
Board (PWB-A) or the Elevator Motor (M7) is
replaced with a new one.
A. Procedure
1. Set the Elevator Tray operation function of the
Test Mode.
2. Turn VR2 on PWB-A fully counterclockwise.
3. Using a sheet of paper, block the Elevator Tray
Upper Limit Sensor LED (PWB-C). Then using
the Elevator Tray operation function, lower the
Elevator Tray.
4. Place 1,500 sheets of A3 (80g/m2) or 3,000
sheets of A4 (80g/m2) paper on the Elevator
Tray.
5. Using the Elevator Tray operation function,
raise the Elevator Tray.
6. While the Elevator Tray is going up, turn VR2 on
PWB-A clockwise and, when LED3 on PWB-A
turns from a steady light to off, stop turning VR2.
1-107
OTHER ADJUSTMENTS 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
A. Procedure
1. Set the staple mode and make a copy.
2. Check the staple position of the paper.
4349D504AA
1 1-108
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 OTHER ADJUSTMENTS
2-Point Staple
I ADJUSTMENT
position
D
C, F 6.0 4mm +1mm to -2mm
D Y 4mm
E X 4mm E
Y = (paper width-x-11) / 2
X = A3, A4: 137
F 4349D505AA
B4, B5: 114
A4R: 190
B5R: 162
Substitute above into the equation.
4349D513AA
A. Procedure
1. Set three gears.
Gear 2
Note:
Set the gears so that the marks on Gears 1 and 3 Gear 1 Gear 3
are aligned with the rib of Gear 2 as shown on the
right.
4349D502AA
1-109 1
OTHER ADJUSTMENTS 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
A. Procedure
1. Set the copier into the Hole Punch mode and
make a 1-sided copy from a 1-sided original.
2. Fold the output paper in half and check whether
the punch hole positions are aligned.
Specification: Within 2mm
4349D501AA
1 1-110
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 OTHER ADJUSTMENTS
I ADJUSTMENT
It is performed when the fold unit is replaced or a
tilt occurs in paper folding.
A. Procedure
1. Enter the Crease mode and make a copy. (A3
Size) A
2. Fold the output paper and half and check Center
whether section A of the paper is aligned.
Specification: 0 1.5mm
3. If the fold position is slanted as shown on the
left, make the following adjustment. Fold
4511D529AA
4511D530AA
1-111 1
OTHER ADJUSTMENTS 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
A. Procedure
1. Set five A4 originals in the ADF.
2. Set to 2-point Staple and Crease mode and A
make a copy. Check whether the staple position
is aligned correctly.
Specification: 0 1.5mm
3. If the staple position is slanted as shown on the
figure, make the following adjustment.
Exit direction 4511D531AA
1 1-112
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 DESCRIPTION OF THE ISW
II ISW 2. SETUP
A. Board used for the ISW
1. DESCRIPTION OF THE ISW The following boards are available for rewriting
a program using the ISW in this machine.
The ISW (In-system Writer) is an operation by SCB (System control board)
which the control program, that is stored in the flash CB (Main body control board)
ROM incorporated into a variety of control boards in FNSCB (FNS control board) : FS-112
the digital copier, is rewritten with the board inte- PWB-A FN (Main control board) : FS-114
grated into the main body of the copier. Executing FAX control
the ISW allows you to renew the version of the con- For the printer controller, see the Service Manual
trol program without changing the board or to install of IP.
II ISW
the latest program while changing the board. For boards other than the above, the ROM is
As a tool to execute the ISW, you can use the [ISW required to be changed.
Trns (PC software)] by which rewriting is made with B. Data flow
a personal computer (PC) connected to the digital There are 2 types of data flows for the ISW as
copier. shown below:
This tools allow direct rewriting of the control pro- PCSCBCBFNSCB/PWB-A FN
gram in the flash ROM included in the copier main PCSCBFAX
body by connecting the ISW connector of the copier
main body. Important:
When the overall control program has not been
The method of carrying out the necessary setup written into the SCB (System control board), it is
work on the main body for executing ISW is not possible to rewrite programs for other boards.
described here. For the operation of the ISW Trns,
see the ISW (In-System Writer) Service Manual. C. Checking before transfer
Before executing the ISW, be sure to check to
Note: see if the transfer case and the transfer mode
to be used are correct.
When using the USB, be sure to turn on the USB
radio button in the [Setting (S)] - [Communication (1) When the overall control program has not
setting (C)] of the ISWTrns and press the OK but- been installed
ton. When the overall control program has not been
For the ISW method of this machine, only the installed, the LCD screen is not displayed and
ISW Trns is available. data cannot be written in the 25 mode.
Transfer case: When the SCB (System control
board) is being replaced.
Transfer mode:When the power is on. (When
the data LED indicator lamp is
on The ISW is waiting for
transfer. When the lamp is
flashing The ISW is receiving
data.)
2-1 3
SETUP 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
(2) When the overall control program has been E. Preparation of the copying machine for ISW
installed transfer
When the overall control program has been When the copier and the PC are USB con-
installed, it is possible to write data in the 25 nected for the first time, it is necessary to install
mode. the USB driver into the PC. (It is not required,
Transfer case: Version up, when boards other however, to install the USB driver on and after
than the SCB (System control the second connection.)
board) are being replaced. For details of the installation procedure of the
Transfer mode:25 mode USB driver, see 3. USB ISW.
Before operating the ISW, maintain the copier
D. ISW connectors in ISW mode.
The ISW connectors are provided on the right
II ISW
side of the main body, and each of the connec- (1) When the overall control program has been
tors is covered with a cap or seal. Be sure to installed
remove this cap or seal while in use. a. Procedure
The following two types of IF are available: 1. Enter the 25 mode.
USB (B type) 2. 25 mode menu screen
IEEE1284 (Nibble/ECP/compatible mode) Press the [10.ISW] key.
In the case of the 7145 3. ISW menu screen
Select the ROM where the ROM data to be
rewritten.
[START] key is displayed.
4. Program rewrite screen
Press the [START] key.
Note:
This step is to be used only when carrying out the
ISW to make a USB connection. When a connec-
tion method other than the above is used, pro-
ceed to Step 6.
In the case of the 7235/7228/7222
5. Program rewrite screen
After confirming that a message Reading pro-
gram data is to be displayed, disconnect once
the USB cable that has been connected to the
copier and then reconnect it again.
Note:
The step is to be used only when carrying out the
ISW to make a USB connection. When a connec-
7322fs2001 tion method other than the above is used, pro-
ceed to Step 6.
3 2-2
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 SETUP
II ISW
trol
Note: a. Procedure
When Steps 4 and 5 are not carried out to make a 1. Enter the 25 mode.
USB connection, the USB port is not opened and 2. 25 mode menu screen
the data cannot be sent from the PC. When the Press the [10. ISW] key.
normal operation of the ISW is not available, start 3. ISW menu screen
all over again from Step 1 after turning the SW1 Select a ROM the data of which is rewritten. The
(main switch) OFF and ON. [START] key is displayed.
Be sure not turn off the power to the copying 4. Program rewrite screen
machine while the ISW data is being written. Press the [START] key.
9. When data has been written into the flash ROM, Note:
the system is restarted to display the 25 mode This step is to be used only when carrying out the
menu screen. ISW to make a USB connection. When a connec-
tion method other than the above is used, pro-
(2) When the overall control program is not ceed to Step 6.
installed
1. Turn on the SW1 (Main power switch) and the 5. Program rewrite screen
SW2 (Sub-power switch). After confirming that a message Reading pro-
2. Check to see if the data LED indicator lamp is gram data is to be displayed, connect the USB
on. In this condition, the ISW is placed in waiting cable.
for transfer.
Check to see if the data LED is flashing while Note:
the ISW data is being received. The step is to be used only when carrying out the
3. The procedure after this is the same as the ISW to make a USB connection. When a connec-
steps above for (1) When the overall control tion method other than the above is used, pro-
program has been installed. ceed to Step 6.
2-3 3
SETUP 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
Note:
When the ISW is carried out to make a USB con-
nection, this step should be omitted.
Note:
When Steps 4 and 5 are not carried out to make a
USB connection, the USB port is not opened and
the data cannot be sent from the PC. When the
normal operation of the ISW is not available, start
all over again from Step 1 after turning the SW1
(main switch) OFF and ON.
Do not turn off the power to the copying machine
while the ISW data is being written.
3 2-4
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 USB ISW
3. USB ISW
The ISW RNs tool for transfer can be installed in the PC by using the setup disk. However, the USB driver
(KCAUSB.SYS) is required to be installed by the plug-and-play of the Windows after connecting the PC and
the copier with the USB cable.
The installation of the USB driver is required only when the PC is connected to the copier for the first time.
(No installation is required on and after the second connection.)
II ISW
3. ISW menu screen
Select the ROM where the ROM data to be rewritten.
[START] key is displayed.
4. Program rewrite screen
Pressing [START] key causes the machine to be data waiting condition.
5. Connect the USB connector.
The Welcome to the Found New Hardware Wizard display is shown.
(The succeeding steps of the B. USB driver installation procedure (Windows 2000/XP)).
2. Select Display a list of the known drivers for this device so that I can choose a specific driver in the
Install Hardware Device Drivers screen, and then click [Next].
2-5 3
USB ISW 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
3. Select the USB driver in the driver selection screen, and then click [Next] for installation.
In the case of the 7145 : Konica Minolta 7145 USB Driver (ISW)
In the case of the 7235/7228/7222 : Konica Minolta 7222/7228/7235 USB Driver (ISW)
II ISW
4. When the Completing the Upgrade Device Driver Wizard screen is displayed, click [Finish] to finish the
installation.
5. In the Device Manager screen, check to see if the installation of the USB driver is carried out correctly.
In the case of the 7145 : Konica Minolta 7145 USB Driver (ISW)
In the case of the 7235/7228/7222 : Konica Minolta 7222/7228/7235 USB Driver (ISW)
3 2-6
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 SERVICE SCHEDULE
III SERVICE
1. SERVICE SCHEDULE
1.1 Service schedule
1.1.1 7145
Guarantee period (5 years or 1,800,000 copies)
III SERVICE
Every 480,000 z z z times
copies
Periodic check (IV) 2
Every 720,000 cop- z z times
ies
DF-318 Maintenance 14
Every 120,000 z z z z z z z z z z z z z z times
copies
Periodic check (I) 1
Every 960,000 z time
copies
Periodic check (II) 1
Every 1,200,000 z time
copies
DB-411 Maintenance 14
Every 120,000 z z z z z z z z z z z z z z times
copies
Periodic check (I) 7
Every 240,000 z z z z z z z times
copies
DB-211 Maintenance 14
Every 120,000 z z z z z z z z z z z z z z times
copies
Periodic check (I) 3
Every 480,000 z z z times
copies
3-1 3
SERVICE SCHEDULE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
1.1.2 7235
Guarantee period (5 years or 1,200,000 copies)
3 3-2
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 SERVICE SCHEDULE
III SERVICE
1.1.3 7228/7222
Guarantee period (5 years or 800,000 copies)
3-3 3
SERVICE SCHEDULE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
3 3-4
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 SERVICE SCHEDULE
III SERVICE
5 Paper (1) Paper feed roller Drum cleaner/
feed unit
z Cleaning pad
(2) Feed roller Drum cleaner/
z Cleaning pad
(3) Double feed Drum cleaner/
prevention roller
z Cleaning pad
(4) Paper dust removing Blower brush/
brush
z Cleaning pad
6 By-pass (1) Double feed preven- Drum cleaner/
feed unit tion roller
z Cleaning pad
(2) Paper feed roller Drum cleaner/
z Cleaning pad
(3) Feed roller Drum cleaner/
z Cleaning pad
7 Fixing unit (1) Fixing claw Drum cleaner/
z Cleaning pad
(2) Fixing sensor Drum cleaner/
z Cleaning pad
(3) Fixing thermostat Drum cleaner/
z Cleaning pad
(4) Fixing heat roller 1 z
(5) Fixing press roller 1 z
(6) Heat insulating sleeve /A 2 Solvest 240 or
z z Multemp FF-RM
(7) Heat insulating sleeve /B 1 z
(8) Fixing idling gear /B 1 Drum cleaner/
z z Cleaning pad
(9) Install of fixing unit
3-5 3
SERVICE SCHEDULE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
Note:
The inlet filters for the FM4/FM7 may get soiled depending on the location in which the machine is placed.
Be sure to clean it when the filter is found clogged with dust while in inspection.
When cleaning is not made properly, toner packing may result due to a temperature rise inside the
machine.
1.2.2 7235/7228/7222
III SERVICE
3 3-6
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 SERVICE SCHEDULE
Note:
The inlet filters for the FM4 may get soiled depending on the location in which the machine is placed. Be
sure to clean it when the filter is found clogged with dust while in inspection.
When cleaning is not made properly, toner packing may result due to a temperature rise inside the
machine.
1.2.3 DF-318/320
III SERVICE
Every 120,000 copies/prints (7145)
Every 100,000 copies/prints (7235/7228/7222)
3-7 3
SERVICE SCHEDULE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
1.2.4 DB-211/411
Every 120,000 copies/prints (7145)
Every 100,000 copies/prints (7235/7228/7222)
1.2.5 LT-203
Every 120,000 copies/prints (7145)
Every 100,000 copies/prints (7235/7228/7222)
III SERVICE
1.2.6 FS-112
Every 120,000 copies/prints (7145 only)
3 3-8
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 SERVICE SCHEDULE
1.2.7 FS-113/RU-101
Every 120,000 copies/prints (7145)
Every 100,000 copies/prints (7235/7228/7222)
III SERVICE
1.2.8 FS-114
Every 120,000 copies/prints (7145)
Every 100,000 copies/prints (7235/7228/7222)
1.2.9 PK-114
Every 120,000 copies/prints (7145)
Every 100,000 copies/prints (7235/7228/7222)
3-9 3
SERVICE SCHEDULE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
1.2.10 SK-114
Every 120,000 copies/prints (7145)
Every 100,000 copies/prints (7235/7228/7222)
1.2.11 BK-114
Every 120,000 copies/prints (7145)
Every 100,000 copies/prints (7235/7228/7222)
3 3-10
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 SERVICE SCHEDULE
III SERVICE
ing unit Developing unit
installing
(2) 36 mode L detection
adjustment
z
5 Main body (1) Ozone filter 1
40LA1017
z
6 Fixing unit (1) Fixing cleaner assembly 1
40LA-540
z
(2) Fixing claw 6
26NA5427
z
(3) Fixing bearing /U 2
26NA5371
z
(4) Fixing bearing /L 2
26NA5359
z
7 Final check (1) 25 mode or 36 mode
Fixing counter reset
z
(2) 36 mode LD1 offset
adjustment
z
(3) 36 mode LD2 offset
adjustment
z
(4) Check of image
adjustment
z
3-11 3
SERVICE SCHEDULE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
26NA4012
2 Transfer/ (1) Transfer corona unit 1
separation 40LA-260 z
corona unit
3 Fixing unit (1) Fixing sensor assembly 1
40LA-534
z
(2) Fuse mounting plate 1
SP00-0110
z
(3) Fixing heater lamp /1 1
40LA8302
z
(4) Fixing heater lamp /2 1
40LA8303
z
3-12
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 SERVICE SCHEDULE
1.3.2 7235/7228/7222
A. Periodic check (I) (Every 200,000 copies/prints)
III SERVICE
adjustment
z
5 Main body (1) Ozone filter 1
40LA1017
z
6 Fixing unit (1) Fixing heat roller 1
26NA5303
z
(2) Fixing pressure roller 1
27LA5304
z
(3) Fixing cleaner assembly 1
27LA-540*
z
(4) Heat insulating sleeve /A 2 Solvest 240 or
26NA5372 z z Multemp FF-
RM
(5) Heat insulating sleeve /B 1
26NA5373
z
(6) Fixing claw 6
27NA5427
z
(7) Fixing bearing /U 2
26NA5371
z
(8) Fixing bearing /L 2
26NA5359
z
(9) Fixing idling gear /B 1 Drum cleaner/
27NA5394
z z Cleaning pad
(10)Fixing sensor Drum cleaner/
z Cleaning pad
(11)Fixing thermostat Drum cleaner/
z Cleaning pad
3-13 3
SERVICE SCHEDULE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
3 3-14
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 SERVICE SCHEDULE
1.3.3 DF-318
A. Periodic check (I) (Every 960,000 copies/prints)
III SERVICE
B. Periodic check (II) (Every 1,200,000 copies/prints)
1.3.4 DF-320
A. Periodic check (I) (Every 1,000,000 copies/prints)
3-15 3
SERVICE SCHEDULE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
1.3.5 DB-211
A. Periodic check (I)
Every 480,000 copies/prints (7145)
Every 400,000 copies/prints (7235/7228/7222)
1.3.6 DB-411
A. Periodic check (I)
Every 240,000 copies/prints (7145)
Every 200,000 copies/prints (7235/7228/7222)
1.3.7 LT-203
A. Periodic check (I)
Every 240,000 copies/prints (7145)
Every 400,000 copies/prints (7235/7228/7222)
3 3-16
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 SERVICE SCHEDULE
1.3.8 FS-112
A. Periodic check (I)
Every 600,000 copies/prints
III SERVICE
3-17 3
SERVICE SCHEDULE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
200,000
(7235/7228/7222)
06 Developing unit 40LA-300 1 720,000
(7145) (7145)
27LA-300 600,000
(7235/7228/7222) (7235/7228/7222)
07 Main body Ozone filter 40LA1017 1 240,000
(7145)
200,000
(7235/7228/7222)
41 Suction filter /A 40LA-318 1 120,000
(7145)
100,000
(7235/7228/7222)
42 Filter cover assembly 40LA-314 1 120,000
(7145)
100,000
(7235/7228/7222)
08 Main body paper feed (Tray 1) Paper feed rubber 40LA4009 1 200,000
09 unit (Tray 1) Feed rubber 26NA4011 1 200,000
10 (Tray 1) Double feed preven- 26NA4012 1 200,000
tion rubber
11 (Tray 2) Paper feed rubber 40LA4009 1 200,000
12 (Tray 2) Feed rubber 26NA4011 1 200,000
13 (Tray 2) Double feed preven- 26NA4012 1 200,000
tion rubber
3 3-18
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 SERVICE SCHEDULE
III SERVICE
(7235/7228/7222) (7235/7228/7222)
25 Fixing cleaner assembly 40LA-540 1 240,000
(7145) (7145)
27LA-540 200,000
(7235/7228/7222) (7235/7228/7222)
26 Heat insulating sleeve /A 26NA5372 2 120,000
(7145)
200,000
(7235/7228/7222)
27 Heat insulating sleeve /B 26NA5373 1 120,000
(7145)
200,000
(7235/7228/7222)
28 Fixing idling gear /B 40LA5394 1 120,000
(7145) (7145)
27LA5394 200,000
(7235/7228/7222) (7235/7228/7222)
30 Fixing claw 26NA5427 6 240,000
(7145) (7145)
27LA5427 200,000
(7235/7228/7222) (7235/7228/7222)
31 Fixing bearing /U 26NA5371 2 240,000
(7145)
200,000
(7235/7228/7222)
3-19 3
SERVICE SCHEDULE 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
Note:
SP is indicated in front of the parts number of
the important maintenance part. Exercise care
when installing the parts according to III. Direc-
tions for disassembly and assembly in this man-
ual.
3 3-20
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 1 PM PARTS KIT
2. 1 PM PARTS KIT
7145
120,000 copies/kit
III SERVICE
7235/7228/7222
200,000 copies/kit
3-21 3
SERVICE MATERIALS LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
3 3-22
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 CE TOOLS LIST
4. CE TOOLS LIST
Tool No. Name Shape Quantity Remark
26NA21340 Drum rotation material 1 Mounted on the drum
unit.
III SERVICE
120A9712 White chart 1 For DF adjustment
DF-320 is contained in
the same package.
00VE-1003 Tester 1
3-23 3
CE TOOLS LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
III SERVICE
Blank page
3-24
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 PARTS LAYOUT DRAWING
IV DIAGRAMS
[1]
[4]
[2]
[3]
7322fs4011
IV DIAGRAMS
[1] TLD (Toner level sensor) [3] PS12 (Tray set sensor /L)
[2] PS9 (Tray set sensor /U) [4] SW1 (Main power switch)
4-1 3
PARTS LAYOUT DRAWING 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
[4]
[3]
[2]
[1]
[1] TDS (Toner density sensor) [3] PS13 (By-pass tray no paper sensor)
[2] VR1 (By-pass tray paper size sensor VR) [4] PS20 (By-pass tray paper size sensor)
[4]
[1]
[2]
[3]
4-2
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 PARTS LAYOUT DRAWING
[2]
[1] [3]
[4]
IV DIAGRAMS
4-3
PARTS LAYOUT DRAWING 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
[8]
[7]
[6]
[1]
[5]
[4] [3] [2]
[1] PS4 (ADU sensor) [5] PS22 (Timing sensor /L) (7145/7235/7228 only)
[2] PS8 (No paper sensor /U) [6] PS10 (Upper limit sensor /L)
[3] PS11 (No paper sensor /L) [7] PS21 (Timing sensor /U) (7145/7235/7228 only)
[4] PS1 (Registration sensor) [8] PS7 (Upper limit sensor /U)
IV DIAGRAMS
3 4-4
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 PARTS LAYOUT DRAWING
[4]
[3]
[2]
[1]
IV DIAGRAMS
4-5
PARTS LAYOUT DRAWING 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
B. Loads
[18]
[17]
[16]
[1]
[15]
[14] [2]
[13]
[12] [3]
[11] [4]
[5]
[10]
[6]
[9] [7]
[8]
[1] M4 (Toner supply motor 1) [10] SD2 (1st paper feed solenoid /L)
[2] M10 (Toner supply motor 2) [11] M9 (Paper feed motor)
[3] SD9 (Toner solenoid) [12] MC2 (Loop clutch)
IV DIAGRAMS
[4] FM7 (Internal cooling fan /2) (7145 only) [13] SD1 (1st paper feed solenoid /U)
[5] M3 (Developing motor) (7145 only) [14] MC1 (Registration clutch)
[6] FM1 (DC power supply cooling fan) [15] M1 (Main motor)
[7] M7 (Tray motor /U) [16] SD5 (ADU gate solenoid)
[8] M8 (Tray motor /L) [17] M11 (Fixing motor)
[9] M6 (ADU motor) [18] M2 (Scanner motor)
3 4-6
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 PARTS LAYOUT DRAWING
[5]
[1]
[2]
[4]
[3]
[1] FM3 (Internal dehumidifying fan /1) [4] TSL (Transfer synchronization lamp)
[2] SD4 (Cleaning web solenoid) [5] FM6 (Internal dehumidifying fan /2)
[3] SD3 (By-pass feed solenoid)
IV DIAGRAMS
[1]
4-7
PARTS LAYOUT DRAWING 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
[4]
[3]
[1]
[2]
[1] L2 (Fixing heater lamp /1) [3] PCL (Pre-charging exposure lamp)
[2] L3 (Fixing heater lamp /2) [4] SD7 (Separation claw solenoid)
IV DIAGRAMS
4-8
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 PARTS LAYOUT DRAWING
[5]
[4]
[3]
[2]
[1]
7322fs4001
[1] PTC (Heater) : Option of the service parts [3] FM5 (Developing suction fan)
setting [4] FM7 (Polygon cooling fan) (7235 only)
[2] FM4 (Internal cooling fan /1) [5] FM2 (Fixing cooling fan) (7145/7235 only)
IV DIAGRAMS
4-9 3
PARTS LAYOUT DRAWING 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
[8] [9]
[1]
[7]
[2]
[3]
[4]
[6]
[5]
[1] CB (Main body control board) [6] SCB (System control board)
[2] FCB (Fixing control board) : only 220V system [7] PRMB (Parameter memory board)
[3] CBR2 (Circuit breaker /2) [8] INV1 (Exposure lamp inverter)
[4] CBR1 (Circuit breaker /1) [9] SCDB (Scanner drive board)
IV DIAGRAMS
3 4-10
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 PARTS LAYOUT DRAWING
[9]
[1]
[8]
[2]
[3]
[7]
[4]
[1] CB (Main body control board) [6] ADUDB (ADU drive board)
[2] FCB (Fixing control board) [7] SCB (System control board)
[3] CBR1 (Circuit breaker /1) [8] PRMB (Parameter memory board)
[4] CBR2 (Circuit breaker /2) [9] INV1 (Exposure lamp inverter)
[5] DCPS (DC power supply)
IV DIAGRAMS
4-11 3
PARTS LAYOUT DRAWING 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
[8]
[7]
[6]
[1]
[5]
[4]
[3]
[2]
[3]
[1]
[2]
[1] PFDB /U (Paper feed detection board /U) [3] HV (High voltage power)
[2] PFDB /L (Paper feed detection board /L)
3 4-12
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 PARTS LAYOUT DRAWING
[3]
[2]
[1]
[1] TCSB (Toner control sensor board) [3] LDB (LD drive board)
[2] INDEX (Index sensor board)
IV DIAGRAMS
4-13
PARTS LAYOUT DRAWING 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
[4]
[5]
[1]
[3] [2]
[1] PS301 (Original no paper sensor) [4] SD302 (Roller pressure solenoid)
[2] SD301 (Paper exit solenoid) [5] PS304 (Cover open/close sensor)
[3] PS303 (DF open/close sensor)
[5]
[6]
[4]
[7]
IV DIAGRAMS
[3] [1]
[2]
[1] PS308 (Original registration sensor) [5] VR301 (Original size VR)
[2] SD303 (Stamp solenoid) [6] PS305 (Original size sensor/1)
[3] PS309 (Original conveyance sensor) [7] PS306 (Original size sensor/2)
[4] PS302 (Original exit sensor)
3 4-14
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 PARTS LAYOUT DRAWING
[1]
[2]
[3]
[4]
[5]
[9]
[8]
[1]
[7] IV DIAGRAMS
[6]
[5] [2]
[4] [3]
[1] PS103 (No paper sensor /3) [6] PSDTB/3 (Paper size detection board /3)
[2] PS108 (No paper sensor /4) [7] HTR100 (Heater) : Option of the service
[3] PS105 (Paper feed sensor /L) parts setting
[4] PS107 (Tray upper limit sensor /4) [8] PS102 (Tray upper limit sensor /3)
[5] PSDTB/4 (Paper size detection board /4) [9] PS104 (Paper feed sensor /U)
4-15
PARTS LAYOUT DRAWING 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
[8]
[7] [1]
[6]
[5]
[2]
[4]
[3]
[1] PS106 (Tray sensor /4) [5] M101 (Tray up drive motor /3)
[2] DBDB (DB drive board) [6] M100 (DB feed motor)
[3] SD102 (Paper feed solenoid /L) [7] SD101 (Paper feed solenoid /U)
[4] M102 (Tray up drive motor /4) [8] PS101 (Tray sensor /3)
[6]
[1]
IV DIAGRAMS
[5]
[2]
[3]
[4]
[1] PS103 (No paper sensor /3) [4] PSDTB/3 (Paper size detection board /3)
[2] PS104 (Paper feed sensor /U) [5] HTR100 (Heater) : Option of the service
[3] PS105 (Paper feed sensor /L) parts setting
[6] PS102 (Tray upper limit sensor /3)
4-16
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 PARTS LAYOUT DRAWING
[5] [6]
[4]
[3]
[2]
[1]
[1] PS109 (Remaining paper sensor) [4] M101 (Tray up drive motor /3)
[2] PS101 (Tray sensor /3) [5] SD101 (Paper feed solenoid /U)
[3] M100 (DB feed motor) [6] DBDB (DB drive board)
IV DIAGRAMS
[3]
[4]
[5]
[6]
[1] LTDB (LT drive board) [6] SD151 (LT paper feed solenoid)
[2] SW151 (Interlock switch) [7] PS153 (No paper sensor)
[3] PS154 (Remaining paper sensor /1) [8] PS155 (Paper feed sensor)
[4] PS151 (Remaining paper sensor /2) [9] PS152 (Tray upper limit sensor)
[5] HTR150 (Heater) : Option of the service [10] M151 (Tray up drive motor)
parts setting [11] M150 (LT paper feed motor)
4-17
PARTS LAYOUT DRAWING 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
[6]
[5]
[4]
[3]
[2]
[1]
[1] M706 (Tray up/down motor) [4] PS703 (Paper exit sensor)
[2] PS706 (Tray lower limit sensor) [5] PS704 (Paper exit full sensor)
[3] PS716 (Tray count sensor) [6] PS711 (Tray upper limit sensor)
IV DIAGRAMS
[5]
[4]
[3]
[1]
[2]
[1] PS710 (Alignment HP sensor /F) [4] PS709 (Alignment HP sensor /R)
[2] M704 (Alignment motor /F) [5] PS707 (No paper sensor)
[3] M703 (Alignment motor /R)
4-18
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 PARTS LAYOUT DRAWING
[1]
[2]
[1] PS708 (Stapler unit HP sensor) [2] M705 (Stapler movement motor)
[2]
[1]
[1] MS701 (Front door switch) [2] FNSCS (FNS control board)
IV DIAGRAMS
4-19
PARTS LAYOUT DRAWING 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
[5] [6]
[7]
[4] [8]
[3] [9]
[2]
[1]
[1] M707 (Paper pressure motor) [6] M702 (Paper exit motor)
[2] MS702 (Shutter switch) [7] M701 (FNS conveyance motor)
[3] PS705 (Shutter sensor) [8] FM701 (Cooling fan)
[4] PS701 (Paper pressure sensor) [9] SD701 (Roller release solenoid)
[5] PS702 (FNS entrance sensor)
IV DIAGRAMS
[4]
[3]
[1]
[2]
4-20
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 PARTS LAYOUT DRAWING
[1] [2]
[3]
[3] [4]
[2]
[1] IV DIAGRAMS
[1] PS25 (IT door sensor) [3] PS24 (IT paper exit sensor /L)
[2] SD8 (Gate solenoid) [4] PS23 (IT paper exit sensor /U)
4-21
CONNECTOR LAYOUT DRAWING 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
37 (W: 8 pin)
1 (W: 8 pin) 27 (W: 8 pin)
2 (BK: 68 pin)
21 (W: 6 pin)
24 (W: 40 pin) 22 (W: 5 pin)
19 (W: 9 pin)
40 (W: 4 pin)
3 4-22
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 CONNECTOR LAYOUT DRAWING
32 (W: 3 pin)
38 (W: 9 pin)
19 (W: 3 pin)
16 (W: 9 pin)
33 (W: 4 pin) 35 (W: 5 pin)
31 (W: 11 pin) 36 (W: 10 pin)
18 (W: 14 pin) 27 (W: 8 pin)
37 (W: 8 pin)
21 (W: 6 pin)
24 (W: 38 pin)
22 (W: 5 pin)
42 (W: 8 pin)
IV DIAGRAMS
432 (W: 24 pin)
45 (W: 4 pin) 44 (W: 22 pin)
32 (BK: 20 pin) 33 (BK: 24 pin) 47 (W: 2 pin)
39 (W: 9 pin)
35 (W: 144 pin)
41 (W: 8 pin)
42 (W: 9 pin)
501 (BK: 44 pin)
40 (W: 36 pin) 502 (W: 3 pin)
4-23 3
CONNECTOR LAYOUT DRAWING 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
57 (W: 9 pin)
502 53 (W: 144 pin) 432 (W: 12 pin)
(W: 3 pin)
42 (W: 9 pin)
40 (W: 36 pin) 501 (BK: 44 pin)
D. DC power supply
IV DIAGRAMS
1 (W: 5 pin)
60 (W: 50 pin)
3 4-24
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 CONNECTOR LAYOUT DRAWING
61 (W: 15 pin)
64 (W: 9 pin)
60 (W: 5 pin)
G. Operation board
84 (W: 13 pin)
83 (W: 4 pin)
86 (W: 14 pin)
H. LD drive board
IV DIAGRAMS
50 (W: 24 pin) (7145)
50 (W: 12 pin) (7235/7228/7222) 7322fs4007e
51 (W: 5 pin)
1 (W: 7 pin)
4-25 3
CONNECTOR LAYOUT DRAWING 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
1 (W: 8 pin)
1 (W: 5 pin)
2 (BK: 24 pin)
1 (BK: 20 pin)
IV DIAGRAMS
O. Display inverter
4-26
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 CONNECTOR LAYOUT DRAWING
7322fs4008
99 (W: 4 pin)
IV DIAGRAMS
4-27 3
CONNECTOR LAYOUT DRAWING 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
101 (9 pin)
100 (6 pin) 106 (19 pin)
1 (5 pin)
1 (5 pin)
3 4-28
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 CONNECTOR LAYOUT DRAWING
101 (9 pin)
100 (6 pin) 106 (19 pin)
105 (3 pin)
1 (5 pin)
IV DIAGRAMS
112 (11 pin)
114 (3 pin)
4-29
CONNECTOR LAYOUT DRAWING 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
F1
IV DIAGRAMS
4-30
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 JAM CODE LIST
During operation
within a predetermined time after SD3 (By- progress at from the bypass
pass solenoid) ON. time of jam, the tray, and remove
copier com- any jammed paper.
Upper J11 PS1 (Registration sensor) failed to turn ON pletes ejection Open the ADU door,
tray within a predetermined time after SD1 (First and then stops. remove any jammed
paper feed solenoid /U) ON. paper. Pull out the
Lower J12 PS1 (Registration sensor) failed to turn ON tray, and remove
tray within a predetermined time after SD2 (First any jammed paper.
paper feed solenoid /L) ON.
DB tray J13 PS104 (First paper feed sensor /U) failed to Open the DB con-
turn ON within a predetermined time after veyance door,
SD101 (Paper feed solenoid /U) ON. remove any jammed
J14 PS105 (First paper feed sensor /L) failed to paperr. Pull out the
turn ON within a predetermined time after tray, and remove
SD102 (Paper feed solenoid /L) ON. any jammed paper.
LT-203 J15 PS155 (Paper feed sensor) failed to turn ON Open the LT top
within a predetermined time after SD151 (LT cover, remove any
paper feed solenoid) ON. jammed paper.
DB tray J16-1 The PS1 (Registration sensor) is not turned Open the ADU door,
ON in the specified period of time after either remove any jammed
of the PS104 (Paper feed sensor /U), the paper.
PS105 (Paper feed sensor /L) and the
PS155 (Paper feed sensor) is turned ON and
IV DIAGRAMS
then turned OFF.
LT-203 J16-2 PS104 (Paper feed sensor/U) or PS105 Open the LT top
(Paper feed sensor/L) failed to turn ON cover, remove any
within a predetermined time after SD151 (LT jammed paper.
paper feed solenoid) ON.
Others J20-2 ADU door open jam Printer section Remove jammed
SW3 (Interlock switch) went OFF during stops immedi- paper according to
copying/printing. ately. message.
Others J20-3 FNS front door open jam
FS-112 MS701 (Front door) went OFF during copy-
ing/printing or, came off from the main body.
Others J20-3 FNS upper front cover open jam
FS-113 PC17 (Front door detection sensor) went
OFF during copying/printing or, came off
from the main body.
Others J20-3 FNS front door open jam
FS-114 The S1-FN (Front cover open/close detec-
tion SW) turned OFF while in copying/print-
ing.
4-31 3
JAM CODE LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
During operation
received from the system while in the system stops immedi- paper according to
emergency stop jam print job. ately. message.
Others J20-5 RU-101 front door open jam
RU-101 PS1 (Front door sensor) went OFF during
copying/printing.
Others J20-6 FNS shutter switch operation jam
FS-112 MS702 (Shutter) went ON during copying/
printing.
Others J20-6 Intermediate transport guide open jam
FS-114 The S4-FN (Intermediate jam guide detec-
tion SW) turned OFF while in copying/print-
ing.
Shutter open jam
The S2-FN (Shutter detection SW) turned
OFF while in copying/printing.
Others J20-7 Top cover open jam
FS-113 PC18 (Top cover detection sensor) went
OFF during copying/printing.
Others J20-7 SK-114 open jam
SK-114 The S4-SK (Saddle safety switch) turned
OFF while in copying/printing.
Others J20-8 Connecting connector coming off jam
FS-113 The FS-113 connecting connector comes off
from the main body during copying/printing.
Conveyance J30 PS1 (Registration sensor) failed to turn ON Open the ADU door,
IV DIAGRAMS
3 4-32
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 JAM CODE LIST
During operation
320 turned OFF while in operation. stops immedi- close cover, remove
J61-2 The PS303 (DF open/close sensor) is turned ately. any jammed paper.
OFF while in operation. Remove any
J62-1 Original did not feed. jammed paper from
J62-2 PS309 (Original conveyance sensor) failed the main bodys
to turn ON within a predetermined time after conveyance sec-
start of refeed for single sided original. tion.
J62-3 PS309 (Original conveyance sensor) failed
to turn ON within a predetermined time after
start of reverse refeed for double sided origi-
nal.
J62-4 PS309 (Original conveyance sensor) did not
go OFF within the specified period after it
went ON, during original exit.
J62-5 PS309 (Original conveyance sensor) did not
go OFF within the specified period after it
went ON, during original reversal.
J63-1 PS302 (Original exit sensor) did not go ON
during original exit.
J63-2 PS302 (Original exit sensor) did not go OFF
within the specified period after it went ON,
during original exit.
J63-3 PS308 (Original registration sensor) failed to
turn OFF within a predetermined time after
start of refeed for single sided original.
IV DIAGRAMS
J63-4 PS309 (Original conveyance sensor) failed
to turn OFF within a predetermined time after
start of reverse refeed for double sided origi-
nal.
J65-1 PS308 (Original registration sensor) ON dur- Open the open/
When idling
4-33 3
JAM CODE LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
When idling
320 (Original conveyance sensor), PS302 (Origi- close cover and the
nal exit sensor) ON during idling state. reverse guide and
remove jammed
paper, if any.
FS-112 J72-1 PS702 (FNS entrance sensor) ON during Remove jammed
idling state. paper, if any, from
the FNS/main body.
FS-113 J72-1 The PS2 (Passage sensor) of RU-101 is Remove jammed
RU-101 turned ON while in idling. paper, if any, from
the FNS/RU/main
body.
FS-114 J72-1 PC4-FN (Entrance sensor) is ON during Remove jammed
idling. paper, if any, from
FS-112 J72-2 PS707 (No paper sensor) ON during idling the FNS/main body.
state.
FS-113 J72-2 While in idling, either of the PC4 (Upper path Remove jammed
sensor), the PC2 (Lower path sensor), PC3 paper, if any, from
(Storage sensor), PC5 (Process tray paper the FNS/main body.
exit sensor) and the PC1 (1st tray exit sen-
sor) is ON.
FS-114 J72-2 PC5-FN (Transport sensor) is ON during
idling.
J72-3 PC8-FN (Storage tray detecting sensor) is
ON during idling.
SK-114 J72-4 PC20-SK (Saddle exit sensor) is ON during Remove jam paper
IV DIAGRAMS
ON within a predetermined time after PS2 body stop paper, if any, from
(Fixing exit sensor) ON. immediately. the FNS/main body.
FS-113 J72-16 After the PS2 (Fixing exit sensor) is turned Remove jammed
RU-101 ON, the PS2 (Passage sensor) of RU-101 is paper, if any, from
not turned ON. the FNS/RU/main
body.
FS-114 J72-16 PC4-FN (Entrance sensor) does not ON Open front door and
after specified time from PS2(fixing exit sen- remove jammed
sor) ON. paper if any.
FS-112 J72-17 PS707 (No paper sensor) failed to turn ON Remove jammed
within a predetermined time after PS702 paper, if any, from
(FNS entrance sensor) ON. (Straight, sort/ the FNS/the main
group mode for other than small size) body.
3 4-34
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 JAM CODE LIST
During operation
not turned OFF. body stop from the main body,
After the PS2 of RU-101 is turned ON, immediately. and remove
the PC1 (1st tray exit sensor) is not jammed paper, if
turned ON. (Sort/Group) any, from the FNS/
After the PS2 of RU-101 is turned ON, main body.
the PC4 (Upper path sensor) is not
turned ON. (Staple)
After the PS2 of RU-101 is turned ON,
the PC2 (Lower path sensor) is not
turned ON. (Staple/Sort/Group)
The PC4 is not turned OFF after it is
turned ON. (Staple)
The PC2 is not turned OFF after it is
turned ON. (Staple/Sort/Group)
After the PC4 is turned ON, the PC3
(Storage sensor) is not turned ON. (Sta-
ple)
After the PC2 is turned ON, the PC3 is
not turned OFF. (Staple/Sort/Group)
FS-114 J72-17 PC4-FN (Entrance sensor) does not OFF Open front door and
after specified time from ON. remove jammed
PC5-FN (Transport sensor) does not ON paper if any.
after specified time from PC4-FN (Entrance
sensor) ON.
FS-113 J72-18 After the PC1 (1st tray exit sensor) is Pull out the FNS
IV DIAGRAMS
turned ON, it is not turned OFF. from the main body,
After the PC3 (Storage sensor) is turned and remove
ON, it is not turned OFF. jammed paper, if
any, from the FNS/
main body.
FS-114 J72-18 PC5-FN (Transport sensor) does not OFF Open front door and
after specified time from ON. remove jammed
paper if any.
FS-112 J72-19 PS702 (FNS entrance sensor) failed to turn Remove jammed
OFF within a predetermined time after turn- paper, if any, from
ing ON. (Staple, sort/group) the FNS/main body.
J72-21 PS707 (No paper sensor) failed to turn OFF
within a predetermined time after PS703
(Paper exit sensor) turning ON. (Small size
staple, sort/group)
4-35 1
JAM CODE LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
During operation
pling, the PC5 (Process tray paper detection body stop from the main body,
sensor) is not turned OFF after it is turned immediately. and remove
ON. jammed paper, if
any, from the FNS/
main body.
FS-114 J72-21 After specified time from stapling, PC8-FN Remove jammed
SK-114 (Strorage tray paper detect sensor) or paper, if any, from
PC20-SK (Saddle exit sensor) of SK-114 the FNS/main body.
does not ON.
FS-112 J72-23 PS707 (No paper sensor) failed to turn OFF
within a predetermined time after PS703
(Paper exit sensor) turning ON. (Straight)
FS-114 J72-25 PC22-SK (Crease roller home position sen- Open front door and
SK-114 sor) does not ON within specified time. remove jammed
FS-114 J72-43 M1-PK (Punch motor) does not OFF after paper if any.
PK-114 specified time from ON.
FS-112 J72-81 Staple jam M708 (Stapler motor) failed to Remove the
turn OFF within a predetermined time after jammed staple.
turning ON. (Forward operation not com-
pleted.)
FS-113 J72-81 After the staple motor 1 starts forward rota- The FNS/main Pull out the FNS
tion, the PC14 (Staple home sensor) is not body stop from the main body,
turned ON in the specified period of time. immediately. and remove
Then, the staple motor 1 starts backward jammed staples, if
rotation and the PC14 is turned ON in the any.
IV DIAGRAMS
3 4-36
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 JAM CODE LIST
During operation
not ON within specified time from saddle sta- body stop staple, if any.
ple motor 1 forward rotation. immediately.
J72-85 Saddle staple home position sensor 2 does
not ON within specified time from saddle sta-
ple motor 2.
IT-101 J75-1 PS23 (IT exit sensor /U) or PS24 (IT exit Open the IT cover,
During operation When idling
J75-10 PS23 (IT exit sensor /U) failed to turn ON Printer section
within a predetermined time after PS2 (Fix- stops immedi-
ing exit sensor) turning ON. ately.
J75-11 PS24 (IT exit sensor /L) failed to turn ON
within a predetermined time after PS2 (Fix-
ing exit sensor) turning ON.
J75-12 PS2 (Fixing exit) failed to turn OFF within a
predetermined time after PS23 (IT exit sen-
sor /U) or PS24 (IT exit sensor /L) turning
ON.
J75-13 The IT door open jam
PS25 (IT door sensor) went OFF during
copying/printing.
Paper J81 PS1 (Registration sensor) ON during idling Open the ADU door,
When idling
IV DIAGRAMS
J82 PS105 (Paper feed sensor /L) ON during Open the DB con-
idling state. veyance door,
remove jammed
paper. If paper is
jammed in the main
body: open the ADU
door, remove the
jammed paper.
J83 PS155 (Paper feed sensor) ON during idling Open the LT top
state. cover, remove any
jammed paper.
Paper J90 PS2 (Fixing exit sensor) ON during idling Open the ADU door,
exit state. remove any jammed
paper.
4-37 1
JAM CODE LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
During operation
conveyance within a predetermined time after start of stops immedi- remove any jammed
ADU reversal. ately. paper.
J97-1 PS4 (ADU sensor) failed to turn ON within a
predetermined time after PS2 (Fixing exit
sensor) ON.
J97-2 PS4 (ADU sensor) failed to turn OFF within a
predetermined time after turning ON.
J100 PS4 (ADU sensor) ON during idling state.
When idling
IV DIAGRAMS
4-38
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 ERROR CODE LIST
abnormalities body control board) body stops SCB (System control board)
Failure in serial communication immediately,
between the SCB (System control and the RL1
board) and CB (Main body control (Main) turn
board). OFF.
F10-2 Communication error at CB (Main CB (Main body control board)
body control board)
Serial communication error to the
sub CPU in the CB, receiving
command error, and platen oper-
ation sequence error.
F10-3 Communication error between CB (Main body control board)
the CB (Main body control board) DBDB (DB drive board)
and DBDB (DB drive board).
F10-4 Sub-CPU A/D conversion error CB (Main body control board)
Two consecutive failures to
respond to CB (Main body control
board) A/D conversion request.
Paper feed F18-1 Error in main body upper tray up CB (Main body control board)
tray abnor- PS10 (Upper limit sensor /L) M7 (Tray motor /U)
malities failed to turn ON within a prede- PS7 (Upper limit sensor /U)
termined time after M7 (Tray
IV DIAGRAMS
motor /U) ON.
F18-2 Error in main body lower tray up CB (Main body control board)
PS10 (Upper limit sensor /L) M8 (Tray motor /L)
failed to turn ON within a prede- PS10 (Upper limit sensor /L)
termined time after M8 (Tray
motor /L) ON.
F18-3 Error in DB upper tray up DBDB (DB drive board)
PS102 (Tray upper limit sensor / M101 (Tray up drive motor /3)
3) failed to turn ON within a pre- PS102 (Tray upper limit sen-
determined time after M101 (Tray sor /3)
up drive motor /3) ON.
4-39 3
ERROR CODE LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
tray abnor- PS107 (Tray upper limit sensor / body stops M102 (Tray up drive motor /4)
malities 4) failed to turn ON within a pre- immediately, PS107 (Tray upper limit sen-
determined time after M102 (Tray and the RL1 sor /4)
up drive motor /4) ON. (Main) turn
F18-5 Error in LT tray up OFF. LTDB (LT drive board)
PS152 (Tray upper limit sensor) M151 (Tray up drive motor)
failed to turn ON within a prede- PS152 (Tray upper limit sen-
termined time after M151 (Tray sor)
up drive motor) ON.
Drum-area F22-1 Internal overheating TCSB (Toner control sensor board)
abnormalities The temperature at the outside of FM4 (Internal cooling fan /1)
the drum reached or exceeded FM7 (Internal cooling fan /2)
58C. (7145 only)
F23-1 PCL connector detached PCL (Pre-charging exposure
When the PCL was being turned lamp) connector
ON prior to the start of initial CB (Main body control board)
charging, a PCL abnormality was
detected 15 times in a row at the
specified intervals after the speci-
fied period of time.
High F26-1 L detection data error TDS (Toner density sensor)
voltage When the L detection output is CB (Main body control board)
power greater than 3.0V.
error F26-2 Abnormal output from TDS (Toner
density sensor)
IV DIAGRAMS
3 4-40
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 ERROR CODE LIST
IV DIAGRAMS
specified period of time. OFF. Accep- DCPS (DC power supply)
F34-2 High fixing temperature abnor- tance of all WARNING
mality (TH2) keys is dis- When F34-, F35- or
The TH2 (Fixing temperature abled. F36- (fixing tempera-
sensor /2) detects a temperature ture related abnormality)
over 236C continuously for a occurs, be sure to repair a
specified period of time. defective part before set-
Low fixing F35-1 Low fixing temperature abnormal- ting the 25 DIPSW 3-1 to 0.
temperature ity (L2 burnt out) If the 25 DIPSW 3-1 is set
abnormalities When turning on electricity to the to 0 without repairing a
L2 (Fixing heater lamp /1) for defective part, this may
more than the specified period of cause a fire.
time while in idling.
4-41
ERROR CODE LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
tempera- ity (L2 burnt out) body stops TH2 (Fxing temperature sensor /2)
ture abnor- In other than warming-up, the immediately, L2 (Fixing heater lamp /1)
malities TH1 (Fixing temperature sensor / and the RL1 L3 (Fixing heater lamp /2)
1) elapses for more than the (Main) turn CB (Main body control board)
specified period of time in a tem- OFF. Accep- DCPS (DC power supply)
perature below 165C (7145)/ tance of all WARNING
160C (except the 7145). keys is dis- When F34-, F35- or
F35-3 TH1 (Fxing temperature sensor / abled. F36- (fixing tempera-
1) low temperature abnormality ture related abnormality)
In warming up, when the tem- occurs, be sure to repair a
perature detected by the TH1 defective part before set-
at the start of turning on elec- ting the 25 DIPSW 3-1 to 0.
tricity to the L2 (Fixing heater If the 25 DIPSW 3-1 is set
lamp /1) is below 160C to 0 without repairing a
(7145)/150C (except the defective part, this may
7145), the difference between cause a fire.
the TH1 temperature at the
time of turning on electricity to
the L2 and the TH1 tempera-
ture after the elapse of the
specified period of time does
not reach the specified value.
When the temperature
detected by the TH1 at the
start of turning on electricity to
IV DIAGRAMS
3 4-42
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 ERROR CODE LIST
temperature ity (L3 burnt out) body stops TH2 (Fxing temperature sensor /2)
abnormalities In other than warming up, the immediately, L2 (Fixing heater lamp /1)
TH2 (Fixing temperature sensor / and the RL1 L3 (Fixing heater lamp /2)
2) elapses for more than the (Main) turn CB (Main body control board)
specified period of time in a tem- OFF. Accep- DCPS (DC power supply)
perature below 165C (7145)/ tance of all WARNING
160C (except the 7145). keys is dis- When F34-, F35- or
F35-6 TH2 (Fxing temperature sensor / abled. F36- (fixing tempera-
2) low temperature abnormality ture related abnormality)
In warming up, when the tem- occurs, be sure to repair a
perature detected by the TH2 defective part before set-
at the start of turning on elec- ting the 25 DIPSW 3-1 to 0.
tricity to the L3 (Fixing heater If the 25 DIPSW 3-1 is set
lamp /2) is below 160C to 0 without repairing a
(7145)/150C (except the defective part, this may
7145), the difference between cause a fire.
the TH2 temperature at the
start of turning on electricity to
the L3 and the TH2 tempera-
ture after the elapse of the
specified period of time does
not reach the specified value.
When the temperature
detected by the TH2 at the
start of turning on electricity to
IV DIAGRAMS
the L3 (Fixing heater lamp /2)
is above 160C (7145)/150C
(except the 7145), the TH2
temperature does not reach
the warming-up completion
temperature in the specified
period of time after the start of
turning on electricity to the L3.
F35-7 Fixing heat roller wrapping jam
failure (TH1)
While in copying, the TH1 (Fixing
temperature sensor /1) detects a
condition in which the tempera-
ture is lower than the specified
one as compared with the tem-
perature taken the specified
period of time previously.
4-43 3
ERROR CODE LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
temperature failure (TH2) body stops TH2 (Fxing temperature sensor /2)
abnormalities While in copying, the TH2 (Fixing immediately, L2 (Fixing heater lamp /1)
temperature sensor /2) detects a and the RL1 L3 (Fixing heater lamp /2)
condition in which the tempera- (Main) turn CB (Main body control board)
ture is lower than the specified OFF. Accep- DCPS (DC power supply)
one as compared with the tem- tance of all WARNING
perature taken the specified keys is dis- When F34-, F35- or
period of time previously. abled. F36- (fixing tempera-
F35-9 TH1 (Fxing temperature sensor / ture related abnormality)
1) contact failure occurs, be sure to repair a
In warming up, when the temper- defective part before set-
ature detected by the TH2 (Fixing ting the 25 DIPSW 3-1 to 0.
temperature sensor /2) reaches If the 25 DIPSW 3-1 is set
the Ready temperature earlier to 0 without repairing a
than the temperature detected by defective part, this may
the TH1, the temperature cause a fire.
detected by the TH1 does not
reach the Ready temperature in
the specified period of time after
the temperature detected by the
TH2 reaches the Ready tempera-
ture.
F35-10 TH2 (Fxing temperature sensor /
2) contact failure
In warming up, when the temper-
IV DIAGRAMS
3 4-44
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 ERROR CODE LIST
ing sensor 1)open abnormality body stops TH2 (Fxing temperature sensor /2)
abnormalities (Sub CPU detection) immediately, L2 (Fixing heater lamp /1)
In the sub CPU, the TH1 detects and the RL1 L3 (Fixing heater lamp /2)
a temperature from -8C to -20C (Main) turn CB (Main body control board)
continuously for the specified OFF. Accep- DCPS (DC power supply)
period of time. tance of all WARNING
F36-3 TH2 (Fxing temperature sensor / keys is dis- When F34-, F35- or
2) high temperature abnormality abled. F36- (fixing tempera-
(Sub CPU detection) ture related abnormality)
In the sub CPU, the TH2 detects occurs, be sure to repair a
a temperature above 236C for defective part before set-
the specified period of time. ting the 25 DIPSW 3-1 to 0.
F36-4 TH2 (Fxing temperature sensor / If the 25 DIPSW 3-1 is set
2) open abnormality to 0 without repairing a
(Sub CPU detection) defective part, this may
In the sub CPU, the TH2 detects cause a fire.
a temperature from -8C to -20C
continuously for the specified
period of time.
Scanner F41-1 M2 (Scanner motor) drive abnor- Scanner stops M2 (Scanner motor)
abnormalities mality immediately. SCDB (Scanner drive board)
Occurs at exposure unit initial (7145 only)
search or at return scan if PS14 CB (Main body control board)
(Scanner home position sensor)
fails to turn ON within a predeter-
IV DIAGRAMS
mined time.
F43-1 L1 (Exposure lamp) abnormality L1 (Exposure lamp)
After the L1 is turned ON, an L1
abnormality signal is detected
continuously after the elapse of
the specified period of time.
Image F46-1 Laser driver abnormality The main Laser diode
control abnor- Caused by overcurrent in laser body stops LDB (LD drive board)
malities output. immediately,
F46-8 Laser index abnormality and the RL1 INDEX (Index sensor board)
Occurs if index period is different (Main) turn M5 (Polygon motor)
from expected value. OFF. SCB (System control board)
Laser route
F46-10 AOC abnormality Scanner stops ADB (A/D conversion board)
AOC counter overflow immediately. L1 (Exposure lamp)
F46-11 AGC abnormality INV1 (Exposure lamp inverter)
AGC counter overflow SCB (System control board)
Exposure unit stop position
4-45 3
ERROR CODE LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
control abnor- nection abnormality body stops SCB (System control board)
malities immediately,
and the RL1
(Main) turn
OFF.
F49-6 ADB (A/D conversion board) con- Scanner stops CCD on ADB (A/D conversion
nection abnormality immediately. board)
SCB (System control board)
Flex wiring harness
Motor speed F51-2 M11 (Fixing motor) speed abnor- The main M11 (Fixing motor)
abnormalities mality body stops CB (Main body control board)
Motor lock detection (LOCK) sig- immediately,
nal has been detected 5 times at and the RL1
the specified intervals. (Main) turn
F51-4 M3 (Developing motor) speed OFF. M3 (Developing motor)
(7145) abnormality CB (Main body control board)
Motor lock detection (LD) signal
has been detected 5 times at the
specified intervals.
F51-5 M1 (Main motor) speed abnor- M1 (Main motor)
(7145) mality CB (Main body control board)
Motor lock detection (LOCK) sig-
nal has been detected 5 times at
the specified intervals.
F51-6 M5 (Polygon motor) speed abnor- M5 (Polygon motor)
IV DIAGRAMS
3 4-46
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 ERROR CODE LIST
IV DIAGRAMS
When the motor lock signal (EM)
was detected at the specified
cycle with [H] detected continu-
ously, the fan has been judged
abnormal at the succeeding two
retries.
F52-6 Printer controller cooling fan Printer controller
abnormality
When an error status signal was
sent from the printer controller.
F52-7 FM301 (Cooling fan) abnormality FM301 (Cooling fan)
When the motor lock signal (EM) CB (Main body control board)
was detected at the specified
cycle with [H] detected continu-
ously, the fan has been judged
abnormal at the succeeding two
retries.
4-47 3
ERROR CODE LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
3 4-48
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 ERROR CODE LIST
communication between system-control of the supply OFF FNSCB (FNS control board)
abnormalities SCB (System control board) and CB (Main body control board)
engine-control of the CB (Main
body control board).
While on standby, the FNS
Ready signal has not been
detected for the specified period
of time.
E56-5 Communication abnormality SCB (System control board)
between system-control of the CB (Main body control board)
SCB (System control board) and
engine-control of the CB (Main
body control board).
Platen-original size notification
timeout.
Operations E56-6 Operation status error SCB (System control board)
unit control Memory access error at copy
abnormalities insertion.
E56-7 Operation management error
Control error at panel manager
E56-8 Operation drawing error 1
Screen-data drawing mismatch
E56-9 Operation drawing error 2
Drawing-component data error
E56-10 Operation panel communication SCB (System control board)
IV DIAGRAMS
abnormality OB (Operation board)
Communication error with the
operating section CPU
Image control E56-11 Machine type judgement abnormality SCB program
communication (Except The type information of the SCB
abnormalities the 7145) (System control board) is different
from the type information of the
CB (Main body control board).
E56-12 Communication abnormality SCB (System control board)
between system-control of the CB (Main body control board)
SCB (System control board) and
engine-control of the CB (Main
body control board). There is no
response from the engine after a
signal is sent for periodic commu-
nication.
4-49 3
ERROR CODE LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
communication between system-control of the supply OFF CB (Main body control board)
abnormalities SCB (System control board) and
engine-control of the CB (Main
body control board). The destina-
tion value RAM area on the
engine side is unjustly rewritten.
FNS F70-1 FNS communication abnormality The main CB (Main body control board)
FNS
communication Failure in serial communication body stops FNSCB (FNS control board)
abnormalities between the CB (Main body con- immediately,
(FS-112/113/ trol board) and FNSCB (FNS con- and the RL1
114) trol board). (Main) turn
FS-112 F70-11 FS-112 flash-ROM abnormality OFF. FNSCB (FNS control board)
Detected checksum error in FNS
flash ROM.
FS-113 F77-1 M8 (Shift motor) drive abnormal- M8 (Shift motor)
ity PC10 (Shift home sensor)
When starting to return to the PC11 (Shift motor pulse sensor)
home position, the PC10 PWB-A (Control board)
(Shift home sensor) is not
turned ON in the specified
period of time after the M8 is
turned ON.
When starting to move to the
shift position, the PC10 is not
turned OFF in the specified
IV DIAGRAMS
3 4-50
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 ERROR CODE LIST
IV DIAGRAMS
FN is locked.
FS-112 F77-3 M704 (Alignment motor /F) drive M704 (Alignment motor /F)
abnormality PS710 (Alignment plate HP
The PS710 (Alignment HP sensor /F)
sensor /F) cannot be attained FNSCB (FNS control board)
in the specified period of time Sensor wiring harness /2
after the start of the alignment Motor wiring harness /2
plate HP search.
The PS710 cannot be passed
through in the specified
period of time after the align-
ment plate starts to move to
the size position.
4-51 1
ERROR CODE LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
1 4-52
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 ERROR CODE LIST
IV DIAGRAMS
turned ON in the specified
period of time after the M12 is
turned ON.
FS-112 F77-6 M705 (Stapler movement motor) FNSCB (FNS control board)
abnormality M705 (Stapler movement motor)
The PS708 (Stapler unit HP PS708 (Stapler unit HP sensor)
sensor) is not turned ON in Sensor wiring harness /2
the specified period of time Motor wiring harness /1
after the start of the home
position search.
The PS708 is not turned OFF
in the specified period of time
after the start of the move-
ment to the 2-staple stand-by
position.
4-53 1
ERROR CODE LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
1 4-54
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 ERROR CODE LIST
IV DIAGRAMS
ple motor 1, saddle staple
does not move from home
position within specified time.
During reverse driving of sad-
dle staple motor 1, it does not
reach the home position
within specified time.
F77-14 Saddle staple 2 drive failure PWB-C SK (Control board)
During saddle staple motor 2 Saddle staple motor 2
driving, it does not move from
home position.
During reverse driving of sad-
dle staple motor 2, it does not
reach the home position
within specified time.
4-55 1
ERROR CODE LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
1 4-56
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 ERROR CODE LIST
PC18-SK (Saddle exit open/ body stops M9-SK (Saddle exit open/
close motor) does not ON immediately, close motor)
within specified time from and the RL1 PC18-SK (Saddle exit roller
press-operation starting of (Main) turn home position sensor)
M9-SK (Saddle exit open/ OFF.
close motor) .
PC18-SK does not OFF
within specified time from M9-
SK separation operation start-
ing.
F77-25 M10-SK (Crease motor ) drive PWB-C SK (Control board)
failure M10-SK (Crease motor)
During M10-SK driving, PC22-SK PC22-SK (Crease roller home
(Crease roller home position sen- position sensor)
sor) does not ON within specified
time.
F77-26 M8-SK (Saddle exit motor) drive PWB-C SK (Control board)
failure M8-SK (Saddle exit motor)
Lock signal ON is continu-
ously detected for the speci-
fied period within specified
time from M8-SK drive start.
Lock signal OFF is continu-
ously detected for the speci-
fied period within specified
IV DIAGRAMS
time from stopping of M8-SK
drive signal.
F77-27 Shutter drive failure 6-FN (Exit open/close motor)
During M6-FN (Exit open/ PWB-A FN (Control board)
close motor) driving (closing PC16-FN (Shutter home posi-
shutter), PC16-FN (Shutter tion sensor)
home position sensor) does
not ON within specified time.
During M6-FN driving (open-
ing shutter) PC16-FN does
not OFF within specified time.
4-57 1
ERROR CODE LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
3 4-58
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 ERROR CODE LIST
memory *1 ately
abnormalities F80-2 Nonvolatile memory abnormality SCB (System control board)
*1
F80-3 Nonvolatile memory abnormality PRMB (Parameter memory board)
*1 SCB (System control board)
F80-4 Nonvolatile memory abnormality PRMB (Parameter memory board)
*1
F80-5 Nonvolatile memory abnormality SCB (System control board)
*1
Flash ROM F81-1 Flash ROM abnormality Engine power SCB program
abnormalities Detected checksum error in SCB supply OFF
(System control board)s
FlashROM.
F81-2 Software abnormality CB program
CB (Main body control board) and SCB program
SCB (System control board) have
non-matching software device
types.
OS F81-4 An OS error occurs in the image SCB (System control board)
error control unit in the SCB (System
control board).
HDD initiali- F82-1 A physical abnormality occurs in SCB (System control board)
HDD
zation abnor- the HDD and a checksum abnor- HDD (Hard disk)
mality mality in the DRAM occur.
HDD abnor- F82-2 Document manager initialization HDD (Hard disk)
IV DIAGRAMS
malities abnormality Reformatting of the HDD
HDD F82-3 I-FAX report initializing error HDD (Hard disk)
error HDD reformat
CB (Main control board)
Access E82-10 Document manager access SCB (System control board)
Main body
4-59 3
ERROR CODE LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
abnormalities NetworkDriver has not been reg- work I/O NetWork section
istered for some reasoen (includ-
ing hardware factors).
Copier/Fax can be used.
F85-2 IEEE1284 device abnormality Stop the SCB (System control board)
IEEE1284 (Parallel) Driver has IEEE1284 IEEE1284 (Parallel) section
not been registered for some rea- (Parallel) I/O
sons (including hardware factors).
Copier/Fax can be used.
F85-3 USB device abnormality Stop the SCB (System control board)
USBDriver has not been regis- USBI/O USB section
tered for some reasons (including
hardware factors).
Copier/Fax can be used.
E85-11 Network protocol stack initializa- Stop the Net- SCB (System control board)
tion abnormality work function NetWork section
The resetting of the Network pro-
tocol stack has been failed.
1 4-60
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 ERROR CODE LIST
abnormalities The resetting of the Network pro- work function NetWork section
tocol stack has been failed.
E85-13 Network print operation abnormality Stop the Net- SCB (System control board)
Software abnormality in the Net- work print JOB, NetWork section
work print JOB sequence. function
E85-14 Network print operation abnormality
Software abnormality when
receiving a Network print signal.
E85-15 Network print operation abnormality
Software abnormality when
receiving a Network print (Apple-
Talk) signal.
E85-17 Network scan operation abnormality Stop the Net-
Software abnormality in the Net- work scan
work scan JOB sequence. function
E85-18 Network scan operation abnormality SCB (System control board)
Software abnormality when send- NetWork section
ing a Network scan signal.
E85-20 MIB module abnormality Stop the MIB
MIB software abnormality function
E85-21 IPP module abnormality Stop the IPP
IPP software abnormality function
E85-22 FTP server module abnormality Stop the FTP
FTP server software abnormality server function
E85-23 WebTool module abnormality Stop the WebTool
IV DIAGRAMS
WebTool software abnormality function
E85-24 eKRDS transmission operation Network
abnormality eKRDS Send-
Software abnormality while in ing function
transmission operation stop
E85-25 eKRDS reception operation Network
abnormality eKRDS
Software abnormality while in Receiving
reception operation function stop
E85-30 LDAP module abnormality LDAP function
No memory obtainable. stop
Improper operation on MIO
LDAP.
HDD abnor- E86-6 FAX file initialization abnormality Stop the HDD HDD (Hard disk)
HDD
4-61 3
ERROR CODE LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
4-62
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 ERROR CODE LIST
IV DIAGRAMS
(Count is made at E89-6.)
E89-25 Carriage return not possible error
Operation abnormality when
copying interrupt.
(FCOT user job)
(Count is made at E89-6.)
E89-26 Carriage return not possible error
Operation abnormality when
copying interrupt.
(Copy print job)
(Count is made at E89-6.)
E89-27 Carriage return not possible error
Operation abnormality when
copying interrupt.
(Copy print job 0)
(Count is made at E89-6.)
4-63
ERROR CODE LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
memory shortage.
E89-42 Scheduling abnormality (mes-
sage transmission error) when
FAX print cannot be started due
to memory shortage.
E89-43 Printer scheduling abnormality
(message transmission error) due
to memory being full.
E89-51 Operation abnormality when
copying interrupt (scanner scan
user job)
E89-52 Operation abnormality when
copying interrupt (scanner mixed
scan job 0)
E89-53 Operation abnormality when
copying interrupt (scanner Z-fold-
ing scan job 0)
4-64
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 ERROR CODE LIST
IV DIAGRAMS
E89-64 Operation abnormality when copy-
ing interrupt (copy mixed scan job
0)
E89-65 Operation abnormality when copy-
ing interrupt (copy Z-folding scan
job 0)
E89-66 Operation abnormality when copy-
ing interrupt (copy normal scan job
0)
E89-67 Operation abnormality when copy-
ing interrupt (copy scan job 1)
E89-80 Suspend occurence
CPU hang up due to software bug
E89-81 Exception occurence
CPU hang up due to software bug
4-65
ERROR CODE LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
*1 Parameter memory board abnormality display priority. For these error codes, the priority for display has
been specified. When two or more errors occur at the same time, they are displayed in the following
order:
1.F80-4
2.F80-5
3.F80-3
4.F80-1
5.F80-2
Note:
For FAX related error codes, see FK/FL Service Manual.
IV DIAGRAMS
3 4-66
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 ERROR CODE LIST
IV DIAGRAMS
upper limit.
N14-04 eKRDS reception abnormality
When the number of attached files
in the E-Mail received is in excess
of the upper limit of 255.
(Since a wrong mail has been
received, the mail is deleted from
the mail box.)
N24 DNS error Stop the LDAP SCB (System control board)
The LDAP server address was function Network section
specified incorrectly.
N25 Connection error
The connection from the LDAP
server was rejected.
N26 Connection error
The LDAP server is correspond-
ing to any version other than 3.0.
4-67 3
ERROR CODE LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
abnormalities The LDAP server does not support function Network section
the SASL authorization system.
N28 LDAP connection error
The MIO does not support the
SASL authorization system which
has been supported by the server.
N29 LDAP connection error Stop the Net-
The log-in name or password is work scan
incorrect. (SMB) function
N30 Network scan operation abnormality
The protocol is not initialized.
N31 Network scan operation abnormality
The connection has been cut off
while in authorization.
N32 Network scan operation abnormality
The host name is incorrect.
N33 Network scan operation abnormality
The user name or user password
is incorrect.
N34 Network scan operation abnormality
The folder name is incorrect.
N35 Network scan operation abnormality
The log-in failed due to the SMB
protocol error other than N30 to
N34.
IV DIAGRAMS
3 4-68
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 ERROR CODE LIST
abnormalities The connection was cut off while in work scan Network section
transfer. (SMB) function
N44 Network scan operation abnormality
The server has run out of free
space while in transfer.
N45 Network scan operation abnormality
An error occurred with the file sys-
tem of the server while in transfer.
N50 Network scan operation abnormality Stop the Net-
The SMTP server address is not work scan func-
set. tion (E-Mail)
N52 Network scan operation abnormality
The protocol has not been initial-
ized.
N53 Network scan operation abnormality SCB (System control board)
The Network connection route is Network cable
abnormal.
N54 Network scan operation abnormality SCB (System control board)
The server is not started. Network section
The port number is wrong.
An erroneous POP server
authentication has been made
for POP before SMTP.
The SMTP server connection
is abnormal.
IV DIAGRAMS
There is not sufficient free
space left in the SMTP server.
N55 Network scan operation abnormality SCB (System control board)
The connection is abnormal. Network cable
N56 Network scan operation abnormality
The communication time has run
out.
N57 Network scan operation abnormality SCB (System control board)
The POP reception is being Network section
made in the same account. JOB
There is not sufficient free
space left in the SMTP server.
N58 Network scan operation abnormality SCB (System control board)
The network connection route is Network cable
abnormal.
TCP/IP setting is disable.
N59 Network scan operation abnormality SCB (System control board)
The SMTP server connection is Network section
abnormal.
4-69 3
ERROR CODE LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
abnormalities The SMTP server connection work scan func- Network section
is abnormal. tion (E-Mail)
The length of time set for POP
before SMTP is longer than
the retention time approved for
the POP server.
N61 Network scan operation abnormality
An attached file in excess of
the maximum size for the
SMTP server has been sent.
The SMTP server was down
while an attached file was
being sent.
N62 Network scan operation abnormality JOB
A reset operation has been
made while in the network
scan operation.
N63 Network scan operation abnormality SCB (System control board)
The size of an attached file is Network section
in excess of the maximum size
for the SMTP server.
There is not sufficient free
space left in the SMTP server.
N64 Network scan operation abnormality
Shortage of the buffer.
IV DIAGRAMS
3 4-70
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 ERROR CODE LIST
IV DIAGRAMS
The IP address is wrong.
The proxy server connection is
abnormal.
N82 Network scan operation abnormality SCB (System control board)
The FTP server was down Network section
while data was being sent.
N83 Network scan operation abnormality SCB (System control board)
The network connection route is Network section
abnormal. Network cable
N84 Network scan operation abnormality SCB (System control board)
The log-in name and the password Network section
are illegal.
N86 Network scan operation abnormality Stop the Net- SCB (System control board)
The network connection route work scan func- Network section
is abnormal. tion (FTP) Network cable
The server supporting the
Passive mode has not been
set to Passive.
4-71 3
ERROR CODE LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
abnormalities The FTP server directory is work scan func- Network section
abnormal. tion (FTP)
The same file as the sending
file has been open on the FTP
server.
N88 Network scan operation abnormality
The reset operation was made
while in the network scan opera-
tion.
N89 Network scan operation abnormality
There is not sufficient free space
left in the FTP server.
N91 Network scan operation abnormality
Shortage of the buffer.
N92 Network scan operation abnormality
The network is in the busy condi-
tion.
IV DIAGRAMS
3 4-72
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 ERROR CODE LIST
IV DIAGRAMS
77-6, 77-11 FNS stapler error FNS stack section Only straight exit remains avail-
able. (FS-112)
77-3, 77-6, Staple drive abnormality FNS The selection of the staple, sort
77-12, 77-28 or saddle mode (stitch-and-fold)
is not available. (FS-114)
77-13, 77-14, Saddle drive abnormality SK The selection of the saddle
77-22, 77-23, mode (stitch-and-fold) is not
77-26 available. (SK-114)
82-2 Document manager initial- HDD Copying, printing (except a per-
ization abnormality sonal letter) remain enabled.
82-3 I-FAX report initialization HDD Copying, printing (except a per-
abnormality sonal letter) remain enabled.
85-1 Network device abnormal- Network Copying and faxing remain
ity enabled.
85-2 IEEE1284 device abnor- IEEE1284 Copying and faxing remain
mality enabled.
85-3 USB device abnormality USB Copying and faxing remain
enabled.
4-73 3
ERROR CODE LIST 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
3 4-74
5.1
Time (sec) 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Item
SD1 (1st paper feed solenoid /U)
PS1 (Registration sensor)
V-Valid
PS21 (Timing sensor /U)
5. TIMING CHART
4-75
M1 (Main motor)
M3 (Developing motor)
SD7 (Separation claw solenoid)
SD4 (Cleaning web solenoid)
HV (Charging corona)
HV (Developing bias)
HV (Transfer corona section)
HV (Separation corona)
PCL (Pre-charging exposure lamp)
TSL (Transfer synchronization lamp)
HV (Paper entrance guide plate)
START button ON
: Does not come ON for some copy counts.
TIMING CHART
IV DIAGRAMS
IV DIAGRAMS
3
5.2
Note:
TIMING CHART
Time (sec) 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Item
SD1 (1st paper feed solenoid /U)
PS1 (Registration sensor)
V-Valid
PS21 (Timing sensor /U)
MC1 (Registration clutch)
MC2 (Loop clutch)
PS2 (Fixing exit sensor)
PS23 (IT exit sensor /U)
This timing chart shows the case of 7235.
A. A4, life size, 2 copies, feed from tray 1
7235/7228/7222 timing chart
4-76
M11 (Fixing motor)
M1 (Main motor)
7322fs4009
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
5.3
V-Valid
4-77
PS4 (ADU sensor)
R 230mm/s
R 230mm/s
M1 (Main motor)
START button ON
TIMING CHART
IV DIAGRAMS
IV DIAGRAMS
3
5.4
Note:
TIMING CHART
V-Valid
PS21
(Timing sensor /U)
MC1 (Registration clutch)
MC2 (Loop clutch)
This timing chart shows the case of 7235.
A. A4, life size, 3 copies, feed from tray 1
4-78
(ADU gate solenoid)
7235/7228/7222 ADU timing chart
F 600mm/s
M6 165mm/s*
(ADU motor)
R 165mm/s*
M1 (Main motor)
* 165mm/s (7235)
140mm/s (7228/7222) START button ON
7322fs4010
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
5.5
Time (sec)
Item 0 1 2 3 4 5 6
Valid (Scan)
M301 F 100mm/s
(Original feed motor)
250mm/s
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
R 460mm/s
DF-318/DF-320 timing chart
230mm/s
A. A4, life size, single side original, 3 sheets
4-79
M302 (Original con- F 460mm/s
veyance motor)
230mm/s
M303 F 230mm/s
(Original reversal motor)
460mm/s
R 460mm/s
230mm/s
START button ON
3
TIMING CHART
IV DIAGRAMS
IV DIAGRAMS
Time (sec) 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
Item
TIMING CHART
Valid (Scan)
M301 F 100mm/s
(Original feed motor)
250mm/s
460mm/s
R
230mm/s
B. A4, life size, double side originals, 3 sheets
4-80
M302 (Original con- F 460mm/s
veyance motor)
230mm/s
M303 F 230mm/s
(Original reversal motor)
460mm/s
R 460mm/s
230mm/s
START button ON
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
5.6
Note:
4-81
V-Valid
START button ON
3
TIMING CHART
IV DIAGRAMS
IV DIAGRAMS
3
5.7
Note:
TIMING CHART
4-82
V-Valid
START button ON
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
Time (sec)
5.8
Item 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
M701 600mm/s
(FNS conveyance motor)
230mm/s
M702 F 600mm/s
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
R
A. A4, sort mode, 2 originals, 2 sets setting
4-83
M703 Alignment/Shift
(Alignment motor /R)
Open
M704 Alignment
(Alignment motor /F)
Shift/Open
M705 F
(Stapler movement motor)
R
M707 Pressure
(Paper pressure motor)
Release
M706 Raise
(Tray up/down motor)
Lower
TIMING CHART
IV DIAGRAMS
IV DIAGRAMS
Time (sec) 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Item
PS2(Main body fixing exit sensor)
TIMING CHART
M701 600mm/s
(FNS conveyance motor)
230mm/s
M702 F 600mm/s
(Paper exit motor)
230mm/s
4-84
M703 Alignment/Shift
(Alignment motor /R)
Open
B. A4, staple mode, 2 originals, 1 position, 2 sets setting
M704 Alignment
(Alignment motor /F)
Shift/Open
M705 F
(Stapler movement motor)
R
M707 Pressure
(Paper pressure motor)
Release
M706 Raise
(Tray up/down motor)
Lower
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
5.9
FS-113 timing chart
Item
L
A. Non-sort, 1 original, 1 copy setting
ON
M1 (Entrance motor) OFF
ON
4-85
M4 (Upper entrance motor) OFF
IV DIAGRAMS
IV DIAGRAMS
TIMING CHART
L 1 2 1 2
4-86
PC3 (Storage sensor) H
ON
M8 (Shift motor) OFF
H Shift position
PC10 (Shift home position sensor) L
Forward
rotation
Stop
M3 (Exit motor) Backward
rotation
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
Item FNS movement starting signal ON
4-87
M15 (Upper paddle motor) ON
OFF
OFF
IV DIAGRAMS
IV DIAGRAMS
TIMING CHART
M1 (Entrance motor) ON
OFF
4-88
switching solenoid) OFF
D. Non-sort, hole punch, 1 original, 1 copy setting
Transport sensor ON
(PC5-FN) OFF
Entrance motor Forward
(M3-FN) Stop
4-89
High
Transport motor Low
(M2-FN) Stop
Exit motor Forward
(M1-FN) Stop
4349T506BA
1
TIMING CHART
IV DIAGRAMS
IV DIAGRAMS
1
TIMING CHART
ON
Punch sensor
OFF
High
Transport motor
Low
(M2-FN)
Stop
Forward
Exit motor
Stop
(M1-FN) Backward
Registration clutch ON
(CL1-FN) OFF
Forward
Punch drive motor
4-90
Stop
B. 1 staple, 2 holes, A4, 2 originals, 2 sets setting
Forward (Retraction)
Exit open/close motor Stop
(M6-FN) Backward (Pressure)
Forward
Alignment motor 2
Stop
(M5-FN) Backward
4349T505BA
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
1st Document 2nd Document
ON
Punch sensor
OFF
Storage tray detecting sensor ON
(PC8-FN) OFF
Entrance motor High
Low
(M3-FN) Stop
Transport motor High
Low
(M2-FN) Stop
Forward
Exit motor Stop
5.11 SK-114 timing chart
(M1-FN) Backward
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
Registration clutch ON
(CL1-FN) OFF
Crease motor Forward
(M10-SK) Stop
Forward
Exit open/close motor Stop
4-91
(M6-FN) Backward
Storage paddle solenoid ON
(SL1-FN) OFF
Forward
Alignment motor 1 Stop
(M4-FN) Backward
Forward
Alignment motor 2 Stop
A. Booklet-binding, 2-point stapling, A4R, 2 originals, 1 set setting
(M4-FN) Backward
Saddle exit open/close motor Forward
Stop
(M9-SK) Backward
Forward
Stapler motor 1
Stop
Forward
Stapler motor 2 Stop
Saddle exit motor Forward
(M8-SK) Stop
4511T504BA
1
TIMING CHART
IV DIAGRAMS
TIMING CHART 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
Blank page
IV DIAGRAMS
4-92
I
F
E
B
A
H
D
C
G
6.1
1
CN201-A 2 CN201-A17
1
CN17-A17 FM301 CN211-A 2 FM301 LOCK CN232-1 Roller pressure
CN17-A16 FM301 CN201-A 3 CN201-A16 CN211-A 3 FM301 ON CN214-A 2 24V
CN201-A 4 CN201-A15 CN214-A 5 DRIVE CN232-2 SD302
CN17-A15 SD303 CN211-A 4 SD303 solenoid
CN17-A14 VR301 CN201-A 5 CN201-A14 CN211-A 5 VR301
CN17-A13 PS305 CN201-A 6 CN201-A13 CN211-A 6 PS305
CN17-A12 PS304 CN201-A 7 CN201-A12 CN211-A 7 PS304
CN201-A 8 CN201-A11 CN214-A 3 24V CN231-1
CN17-A11 PS303 CN211-A 8 PS303 CN231-2 SD301 Exit solenoid
CN17-A10 PS302 CN201-A 9 CN201-A10 CN211-A 9 PS302 CN214-A 6 DRIVE
CN17-A 9 PS301 CN201-A10 CN201-A 9 CN211-A10 PS301
CN17-A 8 SD301 CONT CN201-A11 CN201-A 8 CN211-A11 SD301 CONT
CN17-A 7 SGND CN201-A12 CN201-A 7 CN211-A12 SGND
CN201-A13 CN201-A 6 CN233-2
CN17-A 6 M301 RTN CN211-A13 M301 RTN CN214-A 1 24V
CN201-A14 CN201-A 5 CN233-1 SD303 Stamp solenoid
CN17-A 5 M301 RST CN211-A14 M301 RST CN214-A 4 DRIVE
CN17-A 4 M301 LOCK CN201-A15 CN201-A 4 CN211-A15 M301 LOCK
CN17-A 3 M301 F/R CN201-A16 CN201-A 3 CN211-A16 M301 F/R
CN17-A 2 SGND CN201-A17 CN201-A 2 CN211-A17 SGND
CN17-A 1 M301 CLOCK CN201-A18 CN201-A 1 CN211-A18 M301 CLOCK
CN17-B18 SGND CN201-B 1 CN201-B18 CN211-B 1 SGND
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
2
2
CB(MAIN BODY)
CN201-B13 CN201-B 6 CN214-B 1 B
6. OVERALL WIRING DIAGRAM
CN222-2
CN214-B 7 24V
CN222-5
CN214-B 8 24V
CN222-1 Original conveyance
CN214-A11 B
CN222-3 M302
CN214-A12 B motor
CN222-6
3
3
CN214-A13 A
CN200- 6 CN222-4
CN65- 6 24V CN212- 1 24V CN214-A14 A
CN65- 5 24V CN200- 5 CN212- 2 24V
CN65- 4 PGND CN200- 4 CN212- 3 PGND
CN65- 3 PGND CN200- 3 CN212- 4 PGND
CN65- 2 5V CN200- 2 CN212- 5 5V CN223-2
CN65- 1 SGND CN200- 1 CN212- 6 SGND CN214-B 9 24V
CN223-5
CN214-B10 24V
CN223-1
CN214-A 7 B
CN223-3 M303 Original reverse motor
CN214-A 8 B
CN223-6
CN214-A 9 A
CN223-4
CN212- 7 FG ND CN214-A10 A
CN224-3
CN214-B12 DRIVE
CN224-2
CN214-B13 LOCK FM301 Cooling fan
CN224-1
CN214-B14 PGND
4
4
DFDB
N.C
CN215- 3 5V CN241-1
CN215- 2 PS CN241-2
CN241-3
PS301 No original sensor
CN215- 1 SGND
CN242-1
CN215- 6 5V
CN242-2
CN215- 5 PS PS302 Original exit sensor
CN242-3
CN215- 4 SGND
CN243-1
CN215- 9 5V DF open/close
CN243-2
CN215- 8 PS PS303
CN243-3 sensor
CN215- 7 SGND
5
5
CN244-1
CN215- 12 5V Cover open/close
CN244-2
CN215- 11 PS PS304
CN244-3 sensor
CN215- 10 SGND
CN248-1
CN215- 15 5V Original registration
CN248-2
CN215- 14 PS PS308
CN248-3 sensor
CN215- 13 SGND
6
6
CN246-1
CN216- 6 5V Original size
CN246-2
CN216- 5 PS PS306
CN246-3 sensor/1
CN216- 4 SGND
CN245-1
CN216- 3 5V Original size
CN245-2
CN216- 2 PS PS305
CN245-3 sensor/2
CN216- 1 SGND
CN253-1
CN213- 1 5V
CN253-2
CN213- 2 VR VR301 Original size VR
CN253-3
CN213- 3 SGND
7
7
M303
M302
M301
DFDB
PS306
PS305
PS308
PS302
PS301
PS309
PS304
PS303
VR301
SD301
SD303
SD302
FM301
4-93
Symbol
8
8
Cooling fan
Exit solenoid
Crimp
Symbol
DF drive board
Stamp solenoid
Original size VR
No original sensor
Part name
Connector
Roller pressure solenoid
9
9
6-B
6-B
5-B
1-A
7-B
3-B
5-B
5-B
4-B
2-A
4-B
2-B
Relay connector
Faston
Location
I
F
E
B
A
H
D
C
3
OVERALL WIRING DIAGRAM
OVERALL WIRING DIAGRAM 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
M100
102-6 NC
102-7 F/R
-6
-5
DB paper feed motor PSDTB/3 Paper size detection 5-C
102-8 CLOCK -4
102-9 ON2
102-10 SGND
-3
-2 board /3
102-11 5V -1
PSDTB/4 Paper size detection 5-F
B LT-203 103-A1 24V2
113: 2 - 1
B
101
Paper feed solenoid/U
SD
113: 1 - 2
24V2 110-19 106- 1 24V2
103-A2 DRIVE
board /4
24V2 110-18 106- 2 24V2
111- 2
M101
24V2 110-17
PGND 110-16
106- 3 24V2
106- 4 PGND
103-A3 DRIVE
103-A4 24V2
111- 1 Tray up drive motor/3 M100 DB paper feed motor 5-A
PGND 110-15 106- 5 PGND
M151 DRIVE 110-14
LT CLOSE 110-13
106- 6 M151 DRIVE
J64: 8- 1
M101 Tray up drive motor /3 5-B
106- 7 LT CLOSE 103-A5 SIZE.D 118- 5
M150 F/R 110-12 106- 8 M150 F/R J64: 7- 2
103-A6 SIZE.C -4
M150 CLOCK 110-11 106- 9 M150 CLOCK 103-A7 SIZE.B
J64: 6- 3
-3 PSDTB/3 Paper size detection board M102 Tray up drive motor /4 5-E
C C
J64: 5- 4
M150 CONT 110-10 106-10 M150 CONT 103-A8 SIZE.A -2
J64: 4- 5
103-A9 SELECT -1
SD151 DRIVE 110- 9
PS155 110- 8
106-11 SD151 DRIVE
106-12 PS155
SD101 Paper feed solenoid /U 5-B
PS152 110- 7 106-13 PS152
SD102 Paper feed solenoid /L 5-E
TRAY3
J64: 3- 6 117- 3
PS153 110- 6 106-14 PS153 103-A10 SGND
J64: 2- 7 -2
105
Paper feed sensor/L
PS
PS154 110- 5 106-15 PS154 103-A11 PS
J64: 1- 8 -1
103-A12 5V
PS151 110- 4
LCT_TYPE 110- 3
106-16 PS151
106-17 LCT_TYPE 103-B1 SGND
J63: 6- 1 J69: 6- 1 114- 3 PS101 Tray sensor /3 5-E
J63: 5- 2 J69: 5- 2 -2
102
106-18 5V 110- 2 106-18 5V Tray upper limit sensor/3
PS
103-B2 PS
SGND 110- 1 106-19 SGND 103-B3 5V
J63: 4- 3 J69: 4- 3 -1
PS102 Tray upper limit sensor /3 5-D
D D
J63: 3- 4 J69: 3- 4 115- 3
103-B4 SGND
J63: 2- 5 J69: 2- 5 -2
PS103 No paper sensor /3 5-D
103
No paper sensor/3
PS
103-B5 PS
J63: 1- 6 J69: 1- 6 -1
103-B6 5V
J68: 3- 1 116- 3
103-B7 SGND
J68: 2- 2 -2 PS104 Paper feed sensor /U 5-D
104
Paper feed sensor/U
PS
103-B8 PS
J68: 1- 3 -1
103-B9 5V
MAIN BODY 103-B10 SGND
J66: 3-
J66: 2-
1
2
112- 3
-2
PS105 Paper feed sensor /L 5-C
101
Tray sensor/3
PS
103-B11 PS
J66: 1- 3 -1
24V2 7-5
J60:3 -
J60:4 -
3
4
100-1
100-2
24V2
24V2
103-B12 5V
PS106 Tray sensor /4 5-G
24V2 7-6
E E
J60:7 - 7
PGND 7-7 100-3 PGND
PGND 7-8
J60:8 -
J60:9 -
8
9
100-4 PGND 123: 2 - 1
PS107 Tray upper limit sensor /4 5-F
104-1 24V2
102
5V2 7-10 100-5 5V Paper feed solenoid/L
SD
J60:10- 10 123: 1 - 2
104-2 DRIVE
SGND 7-14
RL PW 7-25
J60:5 - 5
100-6 SGND PS108 No paper sensor /4 5-G
J60:6 - 6 121- 2
M102
RL PG 7-26 104-3 DRIVE
104-4 24V2
121- 1 Tray up drive motor/4 PS109 Remaining paper sensor 3-H
104-5 SIZE.D
J65:11- 1
126- 5
HTR100 Internal heater 3-I
J61: 9 - 1 J65:10- 2
19- 1 101- 9 DB.RTS 104-6 SIZE.C -4
F 19- 2
19- 3
J61: 8 -
J61: 7 -
2
3
101- 8
101- 7
GND
DB.RXD
104-7 SIZE.B
104-8 SIZE.A
J65: 9-
J65: 8-
J65: 7-
3
4
5
-3
-2
PSDTB/4 Paper size detection board F
TRAY4
J61: 6 - 4 104-9 SELECT -1
19- 4 101- 6 DB.CTS
J61: 5 - 5
19- 5 101- 5 GND
J61: 4 - 6
19- 6 101- 4 DB.TXD
J61: 3 - 7 J65: 6- 6 J70: 6- 1 124- 3
19- 7 101- 3 DB.EXIT 104-10 SGND
J65: 5- 7 J70: 5- 2 -2
107
J61: 2 - 8 Tray upper limit sensor/4
PS
19- 8 101- 2 LCT.EXIT 104-11 PS
J61: 1 - 9 J65: 4- 8 J70: 4- 3 -1
104-12 5V
19- 9 101- 1 DB.RST
J65: 3- 9 J70: 3- 4 125- 3
103-13 SGND
J65: 2- 10 J70: 2- 5 -2
108
No paper sensor/4
PS
104-14 PS
J65: 1- 11 J70: 1- 6 -1
104-15 5V
G G
105-3 5V
105-2 SET
105-1 SGND
J60:1 - 1
24V1 7-1
104-16 SGND
J67: 3-
J67: 2-
1
2
122- 3
-2 DB-211
106
J60:2 - 2 Tray sensor/4
PS
PGND 7-3 104-17 PS
104-18 5V
J67: 1- 3 -1
only
DB-411
Only
119-3
H H
-1
-2
Symbol
PS
Remaining 109
paper sensor
Internal heater
J80:1- 1 PTC Connector Faston
I J80:2- 2 J120-1
HTR 100
J120-2
Crimp Relay connector I
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
4-94
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 OVERALL WIRING DIAGRAM
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
MS151
114-2 PGND
FT102(4pin)
114-3 24V2 Interlock switch
114-1 24V
FT101(1pin)
M150 LT paper feed motor 6-C
M151 Tray up drive motor 6-B
B B
SD151 LT paper feed sole- 6-D
121- 1
noid
M151
112-1 24V
121- 2 Tray up drive motor
DB-211 112-2 DRIVE
112-3 PGND
DB-411 PS151 Remaining paper 6-F
112-4 24V2
112-5 24V2
120-11
-10 sensor /2
C 112-6 PGND
112-7 PGND
-9
-8
PS152 Tray upper limit 6-E C
LTDB (H/L) -7
M150
(LD) -6 LT paper feed motor
112-8 F/R
112-9 CLOCK
-5
-4
sensor
112-10 CONT -3
112-11 SGND -2 PS153 No paper sensor 6-E
112-12 5V -1
106- 1 24V2
106- 2 24V2
110-19 24V2
110-18 24V2
PS154 Remaining paper 6-F
D DBDB 106- 3 24V2
106- 4 PGND
110-17 24V2
110-16 PGND
(CN113:miniCT) J82: 5- 1 J84: 2 - 1
sensor /1 D
106- 5 PGND 110-15 PGND 113- 1 24V2
151
J82: 4- 2 J84: 1 - 2 LT paper feed solenoid PS155 Paper feed sensor 6-D
SD
106- 6 M151 DRIVE 110-14 M151 DRIVE 113- 2 DRIVE
106- 7 LT CLOSE 110-13 LT CLOSE
106- 8 M150 F/R 110-12 M150 F/R
106- 9 M150 CLOCK 110-11 M150 CLOCK 113- 3 SGND
J82: 3-
J82: 2-
3
4
127- 3
-2 MS151 Interlock switch 6-A
155
106-10 M150 CONT 110-10 M150 CONT 113- 4 PS Paper feed sensor
PS
J82: 1- 5 -1
113- 5 5V
106-11 SD151 DRIVE
106-12 PS155
110- 9 SD151 DRIVE
110- 8 PS155 HTR150 Internal heater 4-G
106-13 PS152 110- 7 PS152 113- 6 SGND J83: 6- 1 125- 3
152
113- 7 PS Tray upper limit sensor
PS
106-15 PS154 110- 5 PS154 113- 8 5V J83: 4- 3 -1
106-16 PS151 110- 4 PS151
106-17 SGND 110- 3 SGND J83: 3- 4 124- 3
106-18 5V 110- 2 5V 113- 9 SGND
J83: 2- 5 -2
153
113-10 PS No paper sensor
PS
106-19 SGND 110- 1 SGND J83: 1- 6 -1
113-11 5V
126- 3
113-12 SGND
-2
154
113-13 PS Remaining paper sensor/1
PS
F F
-1
113-14 5V
122- 3
113-15 SGND
-2
151
113-16 PS Remaining paper sensor/2
PS
-1
113-17 5V
G G
Internal heater
J120 :1 - 1 PTC
MAIN BODY J121-1 J121-2
DCPS J120 :2 - 2 HTR 150
H J80 :1 - 1 Symbol H
DB
PTC HEATER J80 :2 - 2
Connector Faston
I Crimp Relay connector I
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
4-95
OVERALL WIRING DIAGRAM 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
Blank page
4-96
I
F
E
B
A
H
D
C
G
6.4
CN721-1 CN704-5 A
CN721-3 CN711-1 24V IN2
FNS CN704-1 24V1 MS702
CN721-5 CN704-6 A
Shutter switch
conveyance M701 CN721-7 CN711-2 24V OUT2
CN704-7 B
1
1
CN732-1
CN709-9 5V
Roller CN732-2 PS701
CN762-1 CN709-8 PS Pressure sensor
CN716-1 DRIVE CN732-3
release SD701 CN709-7 SGND
2
2
3
3
CN725-1 CN705-3 A
CN725-5 CN705-2 24V4 CN756-1 CN736-1
Stapler CN725-3 CN707-A15 5V
CN705-4 A CN756-2 CN736-2 PS711 Tray upper limit sensor
movement M705 CN725-2 CN707-A14 PS
CN705-5 B CN756-3 CN736-3
CN725-6 CN707-A13 SGND
motor CN705-1 24V4
CN725-4 CN705-6 B CN756-4 CN734-1
CN707-A12 5V
CN756-5 CN734-2 PS703 Paper exit sensor
CN707-A11 PS
CN756-6 CN734-3
CN707-A10 SGND
CN756-7 CN735-1
1 CN726-1 CN707-A9 5V
Tray up/down CN710-1 DRIVE1 CN756-8 CN735-2 PS704 Paper exit full sensor
M706 2 CN726-2 CN707-A8 PS
CN710-2 DRIVE2 CN756-9 CN735-3
motor CN707-A7 SGND
CN756-10 CN744-1
CN707-A6 5V
CN756-11 CN744-2 PS716 Tray count sensor
CN707-A5 PS
CN756-12 CN744-3
CN707-A4 SGND
CN756-13 CN737-1
CN707-A3 5V
CN756-14 CN737-2 PS706 Tray lower limit sensor
CN707-A2 PS
4
4
CN756-15 CN737-3
CN707-A1 SGND
CN707-B15 NC
FNSCB
CN707-B14 NC
CN707-B13 NC
CN739-1
CN707-B12 5V
CN707-B11 PS
CN739-2 PS708
Stapler unit HP sensor
CN739-3
CN707-B10 SGND
CN738-1
CN707-B9 5V
CN707-B8 PS
CN738-2 PS707
No paper sensor
CN738-3
CN707-B7 SGND
CN740-1
CN707-B6 5V
CN740-2
5
5
CN707-B5 PS PS709
CN707-B4 SGND
CN740-3 Alignment HP sensor/R
CN741-1
CN300-A10 24V CN701-1 24V CN707-B3 5V
CN741-2 PS710
CN300-A9 24V CN701-2 24V CN707-B2 PS
CN707-B1 SGND
CN741-3 Alignment HP sensor/F
CN300-A8 24V CN701-3 24V
MAIN BODY
CN300-A11 NC
CN300-A4 5V CN701-4 5V
CN300-A3 5V CN701-5 5V
5V
PS PS714 Stapler ready sensor
2 CN754-1 SGND
1 CN754-2 2 CN751-1
1 CN751-2
7
7
3 CN752-1
2 CN752-2
1 CN752-3
165 2 CN753-1
164 1 CN753-2
4-97
166
8
8
Crimp
Symbol
Connector
9
9
Relay connector
Faston
I
F
E
B
A
H
D
C
G
OVERALL WIRING DIAGRAM
OVERALL WIRING DIAGRAM 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
4-98
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 OVERALL WIRING DIAGRAM
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
A A
CN300-B3 CN200B-5
MRTS
CN300-B4 CN200B-3
GND
CN300-B6 CN200B-4
MRXD
B CN300-B8 CN200B-2
B
MRTS
CN300-B10 CN200B-6
GND
CN300-B11 CN200B-7
MTXD
C C
MAIN BODY
F F
CN1-1 CN200A-7
DC5V
CN1-2 CN200A-6
Passage sensor PS2 PS2 ON
CN1-3 CN200A-5
GND
G G
CN2-1 CN200A-4
DC5V
CN2-2 CN200A-3
Front door sensor PS1 PS1 ON
CN2-3 CN200A-2
H GND Symbol H
Symbol Part name Location
FUB Fuse board 4-C CN200C-1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
4-99
OVERALL WIRING DIAGRAM 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
Blank page
4-100
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 OVERALL WIRING DIAGRAM
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Hole Punch Position Switch
W W
W W
B Hole Punch Only for inch
B
destination
A Selector Motor
A
B B
PS2 Passage Sensor (RU-101)
C C
D D
E E
PWB-E_GL
PWB-E_GL
PWB-C
F CN200C
F
RU-101
CN201B
G G
PWD-F_GL
PWD-F
PWD-F
PWD-F_GL
PWB-D Connector Faston
I Crimp Relay connector I
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
4-101
OVERALL WIRING DIAGRAM 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
4-102
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 OVERALL WIRING DIAGRAM
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
A A
B B
C C
D D
Saddle Stapler 1 Needle Empty Detect Sensor
FS-114
F FS-114 F
G Symbol G
Connector Faston
H Crimp Relay connector H
FS-114
FS-114
I I
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
4-103
OVERALL WIRING DIAGRAM 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
4-104
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 APPENDIX
7. APPENDIX
7.1 7145 Overall Wiring Diagram (1/4)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
TS
FT20 FT21 FT22
PLUG J21-01 J13-2
24V(C)
J:40LA8861 RL1 CNT
AC(H) CN9-1 Thermostat
FT23
FT24
FT5 Noise filter RT4 RT3
FT3
BT3 FT7 FT8
BT1 MAIN RL
CBR 1 AC(H)
B B
FT2
BT4 CN9-3 FT28
J21-03 J13-4
Circuit breaker/2 CR002 L3 DRIVE L3
FT27
FT4 FT6 BT2
CN9-3 J21-03
Fixing heater
CBR 2 AC(N) BT5 lamp/2
50 CN99-4 SGND
51 CN99-3 SGND BT2 J24: 2 - 2
7-2 24V
Main power switch 52 CN99-2 L3 CONT BT1
7-4 PGND J24: 1 - 1
53 CN99-1 5V
7-12 5V
7-16 SGND FT9 FT10
DC PSY FCB EUROPE Only
7-20 SGND SW1
AC(H) 24V
C 7-18 12V
C
BT6
BT7
5V N.C 2-7
7-22 SGND +12V 5V 2-6
AC(N) -12V
24V 2-5
5-3 PGND NMI 2-4
5-4 PGND 12V 2-3
SGND 2-2
-12V 2-1
3-1 RL CONT
3-2 L2 CONT 5V 7-9
3-3 L3 CONT 5V 7-11
3-4 24V EM DCPS SGND
SGND
7-13
7-15
D 3-5 FM1 EM
12V
SGND
7-17
7-21
D
1 6-2 24V -12V 7-23
for FNS for OPTION SGND 7-24 for DCPS
2 6-4 24V
3 6-6 24V 13 6-1 24V 23 1-1 5V 12V 7-19
4 6-8 PGND 14 6-3 24V 24 1-2 5V
26 25 24 23
for SCDB 5 6-10 PGND 15 6-5 24V 1-3 N.C SW3
6 6-12 PGND 16 6-7 PGND 25 1-4 SGND SWD24V
DF-318 24V 5-1 30
7 6-14 5V 17 6-9 PGND 26 1-5 SGND J23-1 J24-1A #250 J24-1B #250 J23-3
8 6-16 5V 18 6-11 PGND SWD24V
24V 5-2 31
9 6-18 SGND 7-26 RL PGND 19 6-13 5V
7-25 RL PWR
J23-2 J24-2A #250 J24-2B #250 J23-4
E E
10-1 DRIVE
6-20 SGND
7-14 SGND
10-3 PGND
10 20 6-15 5V
7-3 PGND
7-7 PGND
7-8 PGND
42- 9
42- 8
42- 7
42- 6
42- 5
42- 4
42- 3
42- 2
42- 1
31- 7
31- 6
31- 5
31- 4
31- 3
31- 2
31- 1
500- 4
500- 3
500- 2
500- 1
21 6-17 SGND
7-1 24V
7-5 24V
7-6 24V
10-2 EM
7-10 5V
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
12V
-12V
12V
5V
5V
-12V
12V
NMI
24V
5VV
N.C
SGND
SGND
BIAS 8-3 PGND
5V
5V
12
PGND 8-4
83- 1 X2
- 2 Y2 J38-A1 -A12
F PAKB - 3 X1
- 4 Y1
80-A12
80-A11
80-A10
J38-A2 -A11
J38-A3 -A10
34-A1 UD3
34-A2 SGND
34-A3 UD1 F
80- A9 J38-A4 -A9 34-A4 XSCL
80- A8 J38-A5 -A8 34-A5 SGND
80- A7 J38-A6 -A7 34-A6 YD
80- A6 J38-A7 -A6 34-A7 OPTXD
86-14 VLCD J38-A8 -A5
J60:10 - 10
DB-211 32
33
34
35
for CB - 3 DIN
- 2 N.C
- 1 DISPOFF
80- B8
80- B7
80- B6
80- B5
J38-B5 -B8
J38-B6 -B7
J38-B7 -B6
J38-B8 -B5
34-B5 SGND
34-B6 LCDENB
34-B7 OPRST
34-B8 SGND
DB-411
J38-B9 -B4
84-7 VR SIG
84-9 SCAN6
84-2 MONIT
84-12 SGND
J38-B12 -B1
H H
84-4 SGND
84-10 RTN3
84-1 SGND
39 80- B1 34-B12 5V
84-13 SW2
84-8 VR H
84-6 VR L
40
84-11 5V
84-3 5V Symbol
106-11 SD151 DRIVE
106- 9 M150 CLOCK
106-10 M150 CONT
106- 6 M151 DRIVE
106-17 LCT_TYPE
106- 7 LT CLOSE
89-1 FL HOT
106- 8 M150 F/R
-4 FL GND
106-12 PS155
106-13 PS152
106-14 PS153
106-15 PS154
106-16 PS151
106-19 SGND
106- 4 PGND
106- 5 PGND
106- 1 24V2
106- 2 24V2
106- 3 24V2
INV2
106-18 5V
88- 3
-2 Speaker
-1
Connector Faston
85 - 8
85 - 7
85 - 6
85 - 5
85 - 4
85 - 3
85 - 2
85 - 1
I 514: 1 - 2
514: 2 - 1
Crimp Relay connector I
75
76
83 92 97 102
PSW2B
74 82 87 91 96 101
71
72
73
77
78
79
80
81
84
85
86
88
89
90
93
94
95
98
99
100
/SW2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Appendix-1
I
F
E
B
A
H
D
C
G
7.2
APPENDIX
1
1
CN47
46-12 -12 +RCK
46-13 -13 -RCK
46-14 -14 SGND
46-15 -15 SGND
Battery
46-16 -16 +IN_CLOCK
46-17 -17 -IN_CLOCK
2
2
CN501
46-23 -23 SDO
CN502
46-24 -24 SGND
46-25 -25 SGND
FAN
46-26 -26 -AD_D0
J53: A1 - A12 46-27 -27 +AD_D0
103
432-A1 /ENB1
ADB
J53: A2 - A11 46-28 -28 SGND
104
432-A2 /ALM1
J53: A3 - A10 46-29 -29 SGND
7145 Overall Wiring Diagram (2/4)
105
432-A3 /BIAS
J53: A4 - A9 46-30 -30 -AD_D1
106
432-A4 /S/H1
46-31
HD-103 Type A
J53: A5 - A8 -31 +AD_D1
107
432-A5 SGND
J53: A6 - A7 46-32 -32 SGND
108
432-A6 LD+5V
J53: A7 - A6 46-33 -33 SGND
109
432-A7 LD+5V
J53: A8 - A5 46-34 -34 -OUT_CLOCK
110
432-A8 +5VRN
J53: A9 - A4 46-35 -35 +OUT_CLOCK
111
432-A9 SGND
J53:A10 - A3 46-36 -36 SGND
112
432-A10 -VIDEO2
J53:A11 - A2 46-37 -37 SGND
113
432-A11 +VIDEO2
J53:A12 - A1 46-38 -38 ADRST
3
3
114
432-A12 SGND
46-39 -39 APR
J53: B1 - B12 46-40 -40 SGND
115
432-B1 LOAD
J53: B2 - B11 46-41 -41 5V
116
432-B2 DACLK
J53: B3 - B10 46-42 -42 5V
117
432-B3 DI
J53: B4 - B9 46-43 -43 5V
118
432-B4 SGND
J53: B5 - B8 46-44 -44 5V
119
432-B5 /ALM2
J53: B6 - B7 46-45 -45 SGND
120
432-B6 /S/H2
J53: B7 - B6 46-46 -46 12V
121
432-B7 /ALM_RST
J53: B8 - B5 46-47 -47 12V
122
432-B8 SGND
J53: B9 - B4 46-48 -48 12V
123
432-B9 SGND
J53:B10 - B3 46-49 -49 12V
124
432-B10 -VIDEO1
J53:B11 - B2 46-50 -50 SGND
125
432-B11 +VIDEO1
J53:B12 - B1
126
432-B12 SGND
J52: 5 - 1
4
4
127
431- 5 5V
CN35
J52: 4 - 2
128
431- 4 SGND 400-A 1 SGND
J52: 3 - 3
-A 2 BCLOCK12
129
431- 3 /INDEX
J52: 2 - 4 -A 3 SGND
130
431- 2 SGND -A 4 DRAM_D31
J52: 1 - 5 -A 5 DRAM_D30
131
431- 1 /INDPR -A 6 DRAM_D29
DIMM -A 7 DRAM_D28
-A 8 DRAM_D27
-A 9 DRAM_D26
-A10 DRAM_D25
-A11 DRAM_D24
-A12 DRAM_D23
-A13 DRAM_D22
40- 1 STROBE -A14 DRAM_D21
- 2 DATA0 -A15 DRAM_D20
- 3 DATA1 -A16 DRAM_D19
- 4 DATA2 -A17 DRAM_D18
- 5 DATA3 -A18 DRAM_D17
- 6 DATA4 -A19 DRAM_D16
- 7 DATA5 -A20 5V
- 8 DATA6 -A21 DRAM_D15
- 9 DATA7 -A22 DRAM_D14
-10 ACK -A23 DRAM_D13
-11 BUSY -A24 DRAM_D12
-12 PE -A25 DRAM_D11
-13 SLCT -A26 DRAM_D10
-14 AUTOFD -A27 DRAM_D9
-15 N.C -A28 DRAM_D8
-16 SGND -A29 DRAM_D7
-17 SGND -A30 DRAM_D6
-18 N.C -A31 DRAM_D5
-19 SGND -A32 DRAM_D4
5
5
CN32,33
-B 3 SGND
-B 4 XFAX_CIACK
-B 5 XFAX_COACK
-B 6 XFAX_DIACK
6
6
-B 7 XFAX_DOACK
-B 8 XAHA1_INT
PRMB
-B 9 XEXIN_ACK
-B10 XEXOUT_ACK
-B11 -12V
-B12 EXOUT_D7
FK-102/FL-102
-B13 EXOUT_D6
-B14 EXOUT_D5
-B15 EXOUT_D4
-B16 EXOUT_D3
-B17 EXOUT_D2
-B18 EXOUT_D1
-B19 EXOUT_D0
-B20 5V
-B21 EXIN_D0
-B22 EXIN_D1
-B23 EXIN_D2
-B24 EXIN_D3
-B25 EXIN_D4
-B26 EXIN_D5
-B27 EXIN_D6
-B28 EXIN_D7
-B29 XFAX_DRIVE
-B30 XEXOUT_REQ
-B31 XEXIN_REQ
-B32 XICS6
-B33 XFAX_DOREQ
-B34 XFAX_DIREQ
-B35 XFAX_COREQ
-B36 XFAX_CIREQ
-B37 5V
-B38 SGND
-B39 MONITOR
-B40 XRC_INT
-B41 12V
7
7
SCB 2/3
-B42 PDA7
-B43 PDA6
-B44 PDA5
-B45 PDA4
-B46 PDA3
-B47 PDA2
-B48 PDA1
-B49 PDA0
-B50 L_A0
-B51 L_A1
-B52 L_A2
-B53 L_A3
-B54 L_A4
-B55 L_A5
-B56 L_A6
-B57 L_A7
-B58 L_A8
-B59 L_A9
-B60 L_A10
Appendix-2
8
8
Crimp
Symbol
Connector
9
9
Relay connector
Faston
I
F
E
B
A
H
D
C
G
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
I
F
E
B
A
H
D
C
G
7.3
37-1 VEN.TXD
71
24V 21- 6
-2 PGND
72
PGND 21- 5
35-1 -3 VEN.CTS
73
5V 21- 4
1
1
35-2 -4 VEN.RXD
74
SGND 21- 3
35-3 -5 N.C
75
SGND 21- 2
35-4 -6 VEN.RTS
76
12V 21- 1
35-5 -7 PGND
-8 5V
36-1 /M1 24V 20- 1
-2 /PF
30 31
24V 20- 2
-3 /PS0
for SW3
-4 /PS1
77
PGND 20- 3
-5 /PS2
78
PGND 20- 4
-6 /PS3
-7 /SIDE
-8 /CPF0
79
RL CONT 25-A11
COPY VENDER
-9 /CPF1
80
L2 CONT 25-A10
-10 PGND
81
L3 CONT 25-A9
82
24V EM 25-A8
83
FM1 EM 25-A7
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
2
2
for FCB
CONT -3 23-A9 CONT L3 CONT 40- 3
CLK -4 23-A8 CLOCK
50 51 52 53
5V 40- 4
CW/CCW-5 23-A7 SGND
EUROPE only
LD -6 23-A6 LOCK
84
M1
110-19
H/L -7
85
110-18
Main motor
P.G -8 23-A4 PGND
86
110-17
P.G -9 23-A3 PGND J10:12 - 1
87
FT34 FT35
CHARGER
5V -1 23-B1 5V J10: 7 - 6
92
M9
CHG.SIG 15-A11 71- 2 110- 6
H/L -7 J10: 1 - 12
98
110- 4
LT-203
P.G -9
for
23-B9 PGND
100
3
3
110- 2
DCPS
24V -11 23-B11 24V
102
110- 1
12
11
5V -1 72- 1 J16-11
41-11 5V
S.G -2
PGND
41-10 SGND FT30
PLATE
to GUIDE
24V J25-2
CLK -4 41-8 CLOCK
CW/CCW-5 41-7 N.C
LD -6 41-6 LOCK
M11
J17-8
H/L -7 41-5 N.C
P.G -8 41-4 PGND
Fixing motor
CB 1/2
P.G -9 41-3 PGND
J17-11
24V -10 41-2 24V FT38 FT39
24V -11 41-1 24V J25-4 J09-1 70- 9
J09-2 70- 8
J09-3 70- 7
B.CONT 27- 1
J09-4 70- 6
B.SIG 27- 2
FT36 FT37
911: 3 - 1 J28: 3 - 1
Separation Transfer
FM2
J17-7 J17-12 J09-6
4
4
SD9
-2
Toner
18- 1 DRIVE
HUM1
solenoid
Humidity sensor
984-1 J05:3 - 1
29-B16 5V
-2 J05:2 - 2
sensor
29-B15 TLD ANG
TLD
-3 J05:1 - 3
29-B14 SGND
Toner level
J12: 9 - 1 J13:A4 - A1 980:1 - 1
Fixing
-2 J06:2 - 2
29-B12 PS
sensor
PS 5
-3 J06:1 - 3
29-B11 SGND
TH2 ANG 18- 8 J12: 7 - 3 J13:A2 - A3 980:3 - 3
Toner bottle
J12: 6 - 4 J13:A1 - A4 980:4 - 4
TH2
SGND 18- 9
Fixing
986-1
sensor/2
FUSING UNIT
5
5
29-B10 DRIVE
986-2
TC
29-B9 24V
temperature temperature
Total counter
PS 2
926:2 - 1 5V 18-12
29-B8 24V
300:A11- A11
300:A10- A10
300:B10- B10
300:B11- B11
SD5
29-B7 DRIVE
J12: 1 - 9
solenoid
N.C 18-14
ADU gate
Fixing exit sensor
903:6 - 1
29-B6 24V
903:5 - 2
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
29-B5 24V
903:4 - 3 J14: 6 - 1 J17-2 983-1
29-B4 B CONT 25-A1
903:3 - 4
motor/1
M4
29-B3 B J14: 5 - 2 J17-3 -2
12V 25-A2
5V
5V
24V
24V
24V
903:1 - 6
Toner supply
J14: 3 - 4 J17-5 -4
SGND
SGND
PGND
PGND
PGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
29-B1 A
FS SIN
SGND 25-A4
for DCPS
FS CTS
FS RTS
DEV UNIT
J14: 2 -5
FS SOUT
N.C 25-A5
for ENGINE
J14: 1
N.C 25-A6
915:6 - 1
29-A16 24V
Toner density sensor
915:5 - 2
29-A15 24V J15:13 - 1 J16-13
915:4 - 3 N.C 26-B5
29-A14 B J15:12 - 2 J16-14
motor/2
915:3 - 4 N.C 26-B6
M10
29-A13 B
915:2 - 5
29-A12 A J15:11 - 3 J16-2 J11: 7 - 1 92-7
5V 26-B7
6
6
Toner supply
915:1 - 6
29-A11 A J15:10 - 4 J16-3 J11: 6 - 2 -6
DRUM.TH 26-B8
J15: 9 - 5 J16-4 J11: 5 - 3 -5
12V 26-B9
J15: 8 - 6 J16-5 J11: 4 - 4 -4
920: 2 - 1 TNRIF 26-B10
29-A10 DRIVE J15: 7 - 7 J16-6 J11: 3 - 5
TCSB
Registration clutch
925:1J29:1
-2 -2
DRUM CARTRIGE
claw
solenoid
SD4
DRIVE 26-B14
J15: 3 - 11 J16-16 928:1 - 2
solenoid
SD7
24V 26-B15
MC1 Cleaning web
914: 3 - 1 J38: 6 - 1
J15: 2 - 12 J16-12 932:2 - 1
fan/2
29-A5 EM
lamp
PCL
FM6
dehumidifying
912: 3 - 1 J38: 3 - 4
29-A3 PGND
fan/1
912: 2 - 2 J38: 2 - 5
7
7
Internal
dehumidifying
J54:4 - 2 J51:4 - 2 -4
PGND 22-2
Relay connector
Faston
J54:5 - 1 J51:5 - 1 -5
24V 22-1
Polygon motor
907-1
26-B4 24V
-2 201:A1 - A18
M8
5V 17-A18 68-A1
Tray
26-B3 DRIVE
FM301 EM 17-A17 201:A2 - A17
68-A2
motor/L
68-B8
Developing
I
F
E
B
A
H
D
C
G
APPENDIX
I
F
E
B
A
H
D
C
G
7.4
137
136
APPENDIX
135
134
958-1 J31:3 - 1
133
RT3
25-B18 5V
132
-2 J31:2 - 2
25-B17 PS
PS 9
-3 J31:1 - 3
25-B16 SGND
Tray set
sensor/U
5V 16-15 61- 1
961-1 J32:3 - 1
PS14 16-14 61- 2
25-B15 5V PS15 16-13 61- 3
-2 J32:2 - 2
25-B14 PS
1
1
PS17 16-12
200: 1 - 1
200: 2 - 2
200: 3 - 3
200: 4 - 4
200: 5 - 5
200: 6 - 6
-3 J32:1 - 3 61- 4
RT3
PS 12
25-B13 SGND
Tray set
5V 16-11 61- 5
sensor/L
SGND 16-10 61- 6
950-1 J33:3 - 1 J01:9 - 1
L1 EM 16- 9 61- 7
25-B12 5V L1 CONT 16- 8 61- 8
-2 J33:2 - 2 J01:8 - 2
25-B11 PS
sensor
M2 V1 16- 7 61- 9
PS 1
20: 3 - 8
20: 5 - 6
20: 6 - 5
20: 8 - 3
20: 9 - 2
-3 J33:1 - 3 J01:7 - 3
20: 1 - 10
25-B10 SGND M2 V0 16- 6 61-10
Registration
M2 DRIVE 16- 5 61-11
957-1 J01: 6 - 4
M2 EM2 16- 4 61-12
8
6
5
3
2
10
25-B9 5V M2 EM1 16- 3 61-13
-2 J01: 5 - 5
25-B8 PS SGND 16- 2 61-14
PS 8
-3 J01: 4 - 6
sensor
25-B7 SGND M2 CLOCK 16- 1 61-15 for DCPS
956-1 J01: 3 - 7
25-B6 5V
-2 J01: 2 - 8
25-B5 PS
sensor
PS 7
-3 J01: 1 - 9
25-B4 SGND J50: A1 - A12
103
50-A12
-A11
-2 V J50: A3 - A10
M2
105
-2 J40:2 - 2 - A9
25-B2 PS J50: A5 - A8
107
- A8
2
2
-3 J40:3 - 1
PS21
Scanner motor
Timing
25-B3 SGND J50: A6 - A7
108
- A7
sensor/U
J50: A7 - A6
109
-2 63-3 L1 EM - A4
-2 J41:2 - 2 J50:A10 - A3
25-A17 PS
112
-1 63-4 PGND - A3
-3 J41:3 - 1
PS22
25-A18 SGND J50:A11 - A2
113
- A2
INV1
J50:A12 - A1
114
- A1
SCDB
L1INVB
L1
Timing feed
923: 2 - 1 J50: B1 - B12
25-A15 DRIVE
115
50-B12
923: 1 - 2 J50: B2 - B11
LDB
SD2
25-A14 24V
116
-B11
J50: B3 - B10
Exposure lamp
117
J50: B4 - B9
118
922: 2 - 1 -2 64-2 PS - B9
25-A13 24V J50: B5 - B8
PS17
feed
119
SD1
25-A12 DRIVE J50: B6 - B7
120
- B7
J50: B7 - B6
- B6
-2 64-5 PS - B4
sensor
J50:B10 - B3
PS15
124
-1 64-6 5V - B3
J50:B11 - B2
125
924: 2 - 1 J04:11 - 1 - B2
24-B20 24V J50:B12 - B1
126
924: 1 - 2 J04:10 - 2 - B1
SD3
3
3
24-B19 DRIVE
By-pass
solenoid
963-3 64-7 SGND
-2 64-8 PS
PS14
969-1 J08: 6 - 1 J04: 9 - 3 -1 64-9 5V
24-B18 5V
-2 J08: 5 - 2 J04: 8 - 4
24-B17 PS
-3 J08: 4 - 3 J04: 7 - 5
PS20
24-B16 SGND (CN51
By-pass
position sensor
127
51-1
98 -3 J08: 3 - 4 J04: 6 - 6
24-B15 SGND
BYPASS TRAY
128
-2
-2 J08: 2 - 5 J04: 5 - 7
24-B14 VR
129
-3
VR1
-1 J08: 1 - 6 J04: 4 - 8
24-B13 5V J26: 4 - 1
130
-4 -4
By-pass
KC
J26: 2 - 3 985B-1
131
SIG 35- 2 -2 -5
962-1 J04: 3 - 9 J26: 1 - 4 -1 985B-2
INDEX
SGND 35- 3
CN985A
CN985B
24-B12 5V
(Option)
5V
24V
J26: 3 - 2
SGND
N.C
PGND
-2 J04: 2 - 10 985A-3
for KC
24-B11 PS DRIVE 35- 4
-3 J04: 1 - 11
Key counter
PS13
24-B10 SGND SGND 35- 5
sensor
paper feed tray paper tray paper no paper
60- 5
60- 4
60- 3
60- 2
60- 1
953-1 J30:3 - 1
24-B9 5V
-2 J30:2 - 2
24-B8 PS
PS 4
-3 J30:1 - 3
24-B7 SGND
4
4
24-B6 24V
905: 5 - 2
24-B5 24V
905: 4 - 3
24-B4 B
9
7
4
1
905: 3 - 4
M6
24-B3 B
905: 2 - 5 N.C 15-B12
24-B2 A
ADU motor
905: 1 - 6
for DCPS
24-B1 A SGND 15-B11
SGND 15-B10
FS CTS 15-B9
SGND 15-B8
N.C 15-B7
90-1 J02: 7 - 1 FS RXD 15-B6
24-A20 SGND
-2 J02: 6 - 2 SGND 15-B5
24-A19 SIZE.UP.A
J02: 5 - 3 FS RTS 15-B4
For Finisher
-3 24-A18 SIZE.UP.B
-4 J02: 4 - 4 N.C 15-B3
24-A17 SIZE.UP.C
-5 J02: 3 - 5 SGND 15-B2
24-A16 SIZE.UP.D
PFDB/U
70 69 68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60
FS TXD 15-B1
933:2 - 1 J02: 2 - 6
24-A15 SGND
lamp
1-2 J02: 1 - 7
TSL
24-A15 DRIVE
nization
5
5
Transfer
synchro-
(J03:CT)
959-1 J03:11 - 1
24-A13 5V
-2 J03:10 - 2
24-A12 PS
PS 10
-3 J03: 9 - 3
24-A11 SGND
sensor/L
Upper limit
45-4
45-3
45-2
45-1
960-1 J03: 8 - 4
- 9 RI
24-A10 5V
41-9 FG
41-2 TX-
41-10 FG
41-8 N.C
41-7 N.C
41-6 RX-
41-5 N.C
41-4 N.C
J03: 7 - 5
- 8 CTS
- 7 RTS
- 3 TXD
-2
41-1 TX+
- 4 DTR
- 6 DSR
- 2 RXD
41-3 RX+
- 5 GND
VDD
CB 2/2
24-A9 PS
-Data
39- 1 DCD
+Data
41-11 LED2
41-11 LED1
PS 11
SGND
41-11 VDD2
41-11 VDD1
-3 J03: 6 - 6
24-A8 SGND
sensor/U
No paper
LAN USB
KRDS I/F
91-1 J03: 5 - 7
24-A7 SGND
-2 J03: 4 - 8
24-A6 SIZE.LOW.A
-3 J03: 3 - 9
24-A5 SIZE.LOW.B SGND 28-A11
J03: 2 - 10 44-A1
-4 24-A4 SIZE.LOW.C
J03: 1 - 11 EG RXD 28-A10 44-A2
-5
PFDB/L
24-A3 SIZE.LOW.D EG CTS 28-A9 44-A3
EG TXD 28-A8 44-A4
EG TRS 28-A7 44-A5
6
6
S VV 28-A4 44-A8
P VV 28-A3 44-A9
Loop clutch
44-B5
974-1 J42:4 - 4 PS301 28-B6
38- 3 5V 44-B6
-2 J42:5 - 5 EG INT 28-B5
38- 4 PS 44-B7
J42:6 - 6
PS25
-3 EG RST 28-B4
38- 5 SGND 44-B8
sensor
IT door
-2 J42:2 - 2
38- 1 PS
J42:3 - 3
PS23
-3
IT exit
38- 2 SGND
sensor/U
38-B 1 XFAN
38-A 1 XFAN_LK
7
7
-B50 12V
-B49 SGND
-B48 SGND
-B47 12V
-B46 SGND
-B45 -12V
-B44 SGND
-B43 5V
-B42 5V
-B41 5V
-B40 5V
-B39 5V
-B38 SGND
-B37 SGND
-B36 PCI_AD1
-B35 PCI_AD3
-B34 PCI_AD5
-B33 PCI_C_BE0
-B32 SGND
-B31 PCI_AD8
-B30 PCI_AD10
-B29 PCI_AD12
-B28 PCI_AD14
-B27 SGND
-B26 PCI_C_BE1
-B25 XPCI_STOP
-B24 XPCI_TRDY
-B23 SGND
-B22 XPCI_FRAME
-B21 PCI_AD16
-B20 PCI_AD18
-B19 PCI_AD20
-B18 SGND
-B17 PCI_AD22
-B16 PCI_C_BE3
-B15 PCI_AD25
-B14 PCI_AD27
-B13 SGND
-B12 PCI_AD29
-B11 PCI_AD31
-B10 N.C
-B 9 XPCI_REQ0
-B 8 SGND
-B 7 BCLOCK3
-B 6 SGND
-B 5 SGND
-B 4 SGND
-B 3 N.C
-B 2 FANHI
-A50 12V
-A49 SGND
-A48 SGND
-A47 12V
-A46 SGND
-A45 -12V
-A44 SGND
-A43 5V
-A42 5V
-A41 5V
-A40 5V
-A39 5V
-A38 SGND
-A37 SGND
-A36 PCI_AD0
-A35 PCI_AD2
-A34 PCI_AD4
-A33 PCI_AD6
-A32 SGND
-A31 PCI_AD7
-A30 PCI_AD9
-A29 PCI_AD11
-A28 PCI_AD13
-A27 SGND
-A26 PCI_AD15
-A25 PAR
-A24 XPCI_DEVSEL
-A23 SGND
-A22 PCI_IRDY
-A21 PCI_C_BE2
-A20 PCI_AD17
-A19 PCI_AD19
-A18 SGND
-A17 PCI_AD21
-A16 PCI_AD23
-A15 PCI_AD24
-A14 26/ISEL6
-A13 SGND
-A12 PCI_AD28
-A11 PCI_AD30
-A10 NC
-A 9 /GNT2
-A 8 SGND
-A 7 SGND
-A 6 SGND
-A 5 /RST
-A 4 SGND
-A 3 NC
-A 2 SGND
973-1
-2
CN38 Board to Board Connector(100pin)
PS24
-3
IT exit
sensor/L
(CE1)
939: 1 - 2 J42:8 - 8
38- 6 24V
939: 2 - 1 J42:9 - 9
SD8
38- 7 DRIVE
Gate solenoid
Appendix-4
8
8
IP-432
IT-101
J61 : 1 - 9
19- 1 DB_RTS
J61 : 2 - 8
19- 2 SGND
Crimp
J61 : 3 - 7
19- 3 DB_RXD
J61 : 4 - 6
Symbol
19- 4 DB_CTS
J61 : 5 - 5
19- 5 SGND
J61 : 6 - 4
19- 6 DB_TXD
J61 : 7 - 3
19- 7 DB_EXIT
for DB UNIT
J61 : 8 - 2
19- 8 LCT_EXIT
J61 : 9 - 1
32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
19- 9 DB_RST
Connector
910: 4 - 1
9
9
39-4 SGND
910: 3 - 2
39-3 H/L
FM7
910: 2 - 3
39-2 EM
910: 1 - 4
39-1 DRIVE
Internal cooling fan/2
Relay connector
Faston
I
F
E
B
A
H
D
C
G
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 APPENDIX
Symbol Part name Location Symbol Part name Location Symbol Part name Location
COPY VENDER COPY VENDER Appendix-3 1-I M2 Scanner motor Appendix-4 2-E PS24 IT exit sensor /L Appendix-4 7-I
DB-211 DB-211 Appendix-1 2-G M3 Developing motor Appendix-3 8-I PS25 IT door sensor Appendix-4 7-I
DB-411 DB-411 Appendix-1 2-G M4 Toner supply motor /1 Appendix-3 5-I TH1 Fixing temperature sensor /1 Appendix-3 5-E
DIMM DIMM Appendix-2 3-F M5 Polygon motor Appendix-3 7-D TH2 Fixing temperature sensor /2 Appendix-3 5-E
FK-102/FL-102 FK-102/FL-102 Appendix-2 4-A M6 ADU motor Appendix-4 4-I HUM1 Humidity sensor Appendix-3 4-D
FS-112 FS-112 Appendix-3 4-A M7 Tray motor /U Appendix-3 8-I TDS Toner density sensor Appendix-3 5-E
FS-113 FS-113 Appendix-3 4-A M8 Tray motor /L Appendix-3 7-I TLD Toner level sensor Appendix-3 5-I
HD-103 Type A HD-105 Appendix-2 2-F M9 Paper feed motor Appendix-3 3-I TS Thermostat Appendix-1 8-A
IP-432 IP-432 Appendix-4 7-A M10 Toner supply motor /2 Appendix-3 6-I SW1 Main power switch Appendix-1 4-C
IT-101 IT-101 Appendix-4 6-H M11 Fixing motor Appendix-3 3-I SW2 Sub power switch Appendix-1 6-I
KC Key counter Appendix-4 3-E FM1 DCPS cooling fan Appendix-1 4-F SW3 Interlock switch Appendix-1 5-E
LT-203 LT-203 Appendix-3 2-A FM2 Fixing cooling fan Appendix-3 4-I VR1 By-pass tray paper size VR Appendix-4 3-I
TC Total counter Appendix-3 5-I FM3 Internal dehumidifying fan /1 Appendix-3 7-I PTC PTC heater Appendix-1 6-E
DF-318 DF-318 Appendix-3 7-A FM4 Internal cooling fan /1 Appendix-3 9-I BATTERY Battery Appendix-2 2-G
ADB A/D conversion board Appendix-2 1-C FM5 Developing suction fan Appendix-3 9-I
CB Main control board Appendix-3 1-F FM6 Internal dehumidifying fan /2 Appendix-3 7-I
FCB Fixing control board Appendix-1 6-B FM7 Internal cooling fan /2 Appendix-4 9-I
INDEX Index sensor board Appendix-4 3-B MC1 Registration clutch Appendix-3 6-I
L1INVB Exposure lamp power supply board Appendix-4 2-E MC2 Loop clutch Appendix-4 6-I
LCDB Display board Appendix-1 4-F SD1 1st paper feed solenoid /U Appendix-4 3-I
LDB LD drive board Appendix-4 2-B SD2 1st paper feed solenoid /L Appendix-4 2-I
OB Operation board Appendix-1 5-F SD3 By-pass paper feed solenoid Appendix-4 3-I
PAKB Panel key board Appendix-1 4-F SD4 Cleaning web solenoid Appendix-3 6-I
PFDB/L Paper feed detection board /L Appendix-4 5-I SD5 ADU gate solenoid Appendix-3 5-I
PFDB/U Paper feed detection board /U Appendix-4 4-I SD7 Separation claw solenoid Appendix-3 6-E
PRMB Parameter memory board Appendix-2 5-F SD8 Gate solenoid Appendix-4 7-I
PSW2B Power SW2 board Appendix-1 6-I SD9 Toner solenoid Appendix-3 4-I
SCB System control board Appendix-1 8-E PS1 Registration sensor Appendix-4 1-I
SCDB Scanner drive board Appendix-4 1-B PS2 Fixing exit sensor Appendix-3 5-E
TCSB Toner control sensor board Appendix-3 6-D PS4 ADU sensor Appendix-4 4-I
DCPS DC power supply unit Appendix-1 1-A PS5 Toner bottle sensor Appendix-3 5-I
HV High voltage unit Appendix-3 2-E PS7 Upper limit sensor /U Appendix-4 2-I
INV1 Exposure lamp inverter Appendix-4 2-D PS8 No paper sensor /U Appendix-4 1-I
INV2 Display inverter Appendix-1 4-H PS9 Tray set sensor /U Appendix-4 1-I
CBR1 Circuit breaker /1 Appendix-1 2-A PS10 Upper limit sensor /L Appendix-4 5-I
CBR2 Circuit breaker /2 Appendix-1 2-B PS11 No paper sensor /L Appendix-4 5-I
NF Noise filter Appendix-1 3-A PS12 Tray set sensor /L Appendix-4 1-I
L1 Exposure lamp Appendix-4 2-F PS13 By-pass no paper sensor Appendix-4 4-I
L2 Fixing heater lamp /1 Appendix-1 8-B PS14 Scanner home position sensor Appendix-4 3-E
L3 Fixing heater lamp /2 Appendix-1 8-B PS15 APS timing sensor Appendix-4 3-E
PCL Pre-charging lamp Appendix-3 7-D PS17 APS sensor Appendix-4 3-E
TSL Transfer synchronization lamp Appendix-4 5-I PS20 By-pass tray paper size sensor Appendix-4 3-I
LCD LCD Appendix-1 4-F PS21 Timing sensor /U Appendix-4 2-I
BL Back light Appendix-1 4-H PS22 Timing sensor /L Appendix-4 2-I
M1 Main motor Appendix-3 2-I PS23 IT exit sensor /U Appendix-4 7-I
Appendix-5
APPENDIX 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
TS
J21-01 J13-2 FT20 FT21 FT22
Symbol
24V(C)
PLUG RL1 CNT
AC(H) CN9-1 Thermostat
RL1 POWER
FT23
FT24
FT5 Noise filter RT4 RT3
FT3 BT1 BT3 FT7 MAIN RL FT8 4 4
CBR 1
Circuit breaker/1
AC(H)
Fixing heater
Connector Faston
PLUG
INLET FT1 CN9-2
J21-02 J13-3
FT26
lamp/1
Crimp Relay connector
EUROPE 200-240V 50Hz NF AC DRIVE L2
CR001 L2 DRIVE FT25
USA 120V 60Hz
FT2
BT4 CN9-3 FT28
B Circuit breaker/2
FT4 FT6 BT2
CR002 L3 DRIVE
J21-03 J13-4
FT27
L3
Fixing heater
B
CN9-3 J21-03
CBR 2 AC(N) BT5 lamp/2
50 CN99-4 SGND
51 CN99-3 SGND BT2
7-2 24V J24: 2 - 2
Main power switch
52 CN99-2 L3 CONT
7-4 PGND BT1
53 CN99-1 5V J24: 1 - 1
7-12 5V
FT9 FT10
7-16 SGND CN11-2
SW1
CN11-1
DC PSY FCB EUROPE Only
7-20 SGND AC(H) 24V
BT6
BT7
7-18 12V 5V N.C 2-6
C 7-22 SGND
BT8
12V 2-2
SGND 2-1
5-3 PGND
5-4 PGND
DCPS N.C 7-9
5V 7-11
3-1 RL CONT SGND 7-13
3-2 L2 CONT SGND 7-15
D 3-3
3-4
L3 CONT
24V EM
for OPTION for FNS
12V 7-17
SGND 7-21
N.C 7-23
D
3-5 FM1 EM 23 1-1 5V 13 6-1 24V
SGND 7-24 for DCPS
24 1-2 5V 14 6-3 24V
1-3 N.C 15 6-5 24V 12V 7-19
6-14 N.C 25 1-4 SGND 16 6-7 PGND
6-18 N.C 26 1-5 SGND 17 6-9 PGND SW3 26 25 24 23
12V 42- 9
SGND 42- 8
N.C 42- 7
SGND 42- 6
12V 42- 5
SGND 42- 4
SGND 42- 3
5V 42- 2
5V 42- 1
SGND 43- 6
12V 43- 5
NMI 43- 4
24V EM 43- 3
5V EM 43- 2
N.C 43- 1
SGND 500- 1
SGND 500- 2
5V 500- 3
5V 500- 4
10 6-20 SGND OPTIONAL
PTC
24V 8-2
10-1 DRIVE
7-14 SGND
10-3 PGND
7-3 PGND
7-7 PGND
7-8 PGND
935-1 935-2
7-1 24V
7-5 24V
7-6 24V
10-2 EM
7-10 5V
PGND 8-4
F J38-A1 -A14
F
80-A14 52-A1 UD3
83- 1 X2 J38-A2 -A13
80-A13 52-A2 SGND
- 2 Y2 J38-A3 -A12
52-A3 UD1
FM1
PAKB - 3 X1
80-A12
80-A11
J38-A4 -A11
52-A4 XSCL
J60:10 - 10
J60: 1 - 1
J60: 2 - 2
J60: 3 - 3
J60: 4 - 4
J60: 7 - 7
J60: 8 - 8
J60: 9 - 9
- 4 Y1 J38-A5 -A10
80-A10 52-A5 SGND
- 5
- 6
J38-A6 -A9
80- A9 52-A6 YD
J38-A7 -A8
80- A8 52-A7 OPTXD
DCPS cooling fan J38-A8 -A7
80- A7 52-A8 SGND
J38-A9 -A6
80- A6 52-A9 OPRTS
86-14 VLCD J38-A10 -A5
80- A5 52-A10 OPRXD
G -13 VEE
-12 D3
80- A4
J38-A11 -A4
J38-A12 -A3
52-A11 SGND
G
-11 D2
80- A3
J38-A13 -A2
52-A12 OPCTS
SCB 1/3
DB-211
80- A2 52-A13 DF INT
-10 D1 J38-A14 -A1
80- A1 52-A14 APS INT
- 9 D0
39 J38-B8 -B7
106-17 LCT TYPE
40
106- 8 M150 F/R
J38-B9 -B6
80- B6 52-B9 OPINT
106-12 PS155
106-13 PS152
106-14 PS153
106-15 PS154
106-16 PS151
106-19 SGND
106-18 5V
80- B4 52-B11 5V
J38-B12 -B3
80- B3 52-B12 5V
84-7 VR SIG
84-9 SCAN6
84-2 MONIT
84-12 SGND
84-4 SGND
84-10 RTN3
84-1 SGND
J38-B13 -B2
84-13 SW2
84-8 VR H
80- B2 52-B13 SYS STOP
84-6 VR L
J38-B14 -B1
84-11 5V
84-3 5V
80- B1 52-B14 MODE
89-1 FL HOT
-4 FL GND
I 76
INV2 88- 3
-2
I
75 85 94 99 104 112
74 84 89 93 98 103 -1 111
73 83 88 92 97 102 107 110
72 78 80 82 87 91 96 101 106 109 114
71 77 79 81 86 90 95 100 105 108 113
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Appendix-6
I
F
E
B
A
H
D
C
G
7.6
1
1
J50: 1 - 12 J53: 1 - 12
50-12 432-12 LD 5V
J50: 2 - 11 J53: 2 - 11 46- 1 60- 1 SGND
-11 432-11 SGND
J50: 3 - 10 J53: 3 - 10 46- 2 - 2 TG
-10 432-10 /S/H
J50: 4 - 9 J53: 4 - 9 46- 3 - 3 CLAMP
-9 432- 9 /ENB
J50: 5 - 8 J53: 5 - 8 46- 4 - 4 ACLAMP
-8 432- 8 VIDEO+
J50: 6 - 7 J53: 6 - 7 46- 5 - 5 BCLAMP
-7 432- 7 VIDEO-
J50: 7 - 6 J53: 7 - 6 46- 6 - 6 SGND
-6 432- 6 /ALM
J50: 8 - 5 J53: 8 - 5 46- 7 - 7 SGMD
LDB
-5 432- 5 /RESET
46- 8 - 8 +TCK
CN47
J50: 9 - 4 J53: 9 - 4
-4 432- 4 DACLK
J50:10 - 3 J53:10 - 3 46- 9 - 9 -TCK
-3 432- 3 DI
J50:11 - 2 J53:11 - 2 46-10 -10 SGND
-2 432- 2 LOAD
J50:12 - 1 J53:12 - 1 46-11 -11 SGND
-1 432- 1 LPR 5V
Battery
46-12 -12 +RCK
46-13 -13 -RCK
46-14 -14 SGND
46-15 -15 SGND
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
2
2
CN501
46-19 -19 SCLOCK
CN502
46-20 -20 SCLOCK
46-21 -21 *SEN
HD-103 Type A
J52: 5 - 1
51-1 431- 5 5V
FAN
46-22 -22 SDI
J52: 4 - 2
-2 431- 4 SGND 46-23 -23 SDO
J52: 3 - 3
-3 431- 3 /INDEX 46-24 -24 SGND
J52: 2 - 4
-4 431- 2 SGND 46-25 -25 SGND
J52: 1 - 5
-5 431- 1 /INDPR 46-26 -26 -AD_D0
INDEX
46-27 -27 +AD_D0
ADB
3
3
CN53
-42 5V
7235/7228/7222 Overall Wiring Diagram (2/4)
46-43 -43 5V
46-44 -44 5V
46-45 -45 SGND
46-46 -46 12V
46-47 -47 12V
40- 1 STROBE
46-48 -48 12V
- 2 DATA0 46-49 -49 12V
- 3 DATA1
- 4 DATA2 46-50 -50 SGND
- 5 DATA3
- 6 DATA4
- 7 DATA5
- 8 DATA6
- 9 DATA7
-10 ACK
-11 BUSY
-12 PE
-13 SLCT
-14 AUTOFD
-15 N.C
-16 SGND
-17 SGND
-18 N.C
4
4
-19 SGND
-20 SGND
-19 SGND 400-A 1 SGND
-22 SGND -A 2 BCLK12
CN58,59
-A23 DRAM_D13
-A24 DRAM_D12
-A25 DRAM_D11
48-4
48-3
48-2
48-1
-A26 DRAM_D10
-A27 DRAM_D9
- 9 RI
-A28 DRAM_D8
- 8 CTS
- 7 RTS
- 3 TXD
- 4 DTR
- 6 DSR
- 2 RXD
- 5 GND
-A29 DRAM_D7
VDD
GND
-Data
57- 1 DCD
+Data
-A30 DRAM_D6
-A31 DRAM_D5
-A32 DRAM_D4
5
5
6
6
-B 7 XFAX_DOACK
-B 8 XAHA1_INT
-B 9 XEXIN_ACK
-B10 XEXOUT_ACK
-B11 -12V
-B12 EXOUT_D7
FK-103/FL-103
-B13 EXOUT_D6
-B14 EXOUT_D5
-B15 EXOUT_D4
-B16 EXOUT_D3
-B17 EXOUT_D2
-B18 EXOUT_D1
-B19 EXOUT_D0
-B20 5V
-B21 EXIN_D0
CN55 Board to Board Connector
-B22 EXIN_D1
-B23 EXIN_D2
-B24 EXIN_D3
-B25 EXIN_D4
-B26 EXIN_D5
-B27 EXIN_D6
-B28 EXIN_D7
-B29 XFAX_DRIVE
-B30 XEXOUT_REQ
-B31 XEXIN_REQ
-B32 XICS6
-B33 XFAX_DOREQ
-B34 XFAX_DIREQ
-B35 XFAX_COREQ
-B36 XFAX_CIREQ
-B37 5V
-B38 SGND
-B39 MONITOR
-B40 XRC_INT
7
7
-B41 12V
-B42 PDA7
-B43 PDA6
-B44 PDA5
-B45 PDA4
-B46 PDA3
-B47 PDA2
-B48 PDA1
-B49 PDA0
-B50 L_A0
-B51 L_A1
-B52 L_A2
-B53 L_A3
-B54 L_A4
-B55 L_A5
-B56 L_A6
-B57 L_A7
-B58 L_A8
-B59 L_A9
-B60 L_A10
-B43 5V
-B42 5V
-B41 5V
-B40 5V
-B39 5V
-A43 5V
-A42 5V
-A41 5V
-A40 5V
-A39 5V
-B 3 N.C
-A 3 N.C
-B10 N.C
-A10 N.C
-B50 12V
-B47 12V
-A50 12V
-A47 12V
-A 5 /RST
-A25 PAR
-B45 -12V
-A45 -12V
56-B 1 XFAN
-B 8 SGND
-B 6 SGND
-B 5 SGND
-B 4 SGND
-A 8 SGND
-A 7 SGND
-A 6 SGND
-A 4 SGND
-A 2 SGND
-A 9 /GNT2
-B 2 FANHI
-B49 SGND
-B48 SGND
-B46 SGND
-B44 SGND
-B38 SGND
-B37 SGND
-B32 SGND
-B27 SGND
-B23 SGND
-B18 SGND
-B13 SGND
-B 7 BCLK3
-A49 SGND
-A48 SGND
-A46 SGND
-A44 SGND
-A38 SGND
-A37 SGND
-A32 SGND
-A27 SGND
-A23 SGND
-A18 SGND
-A13 SGND
56-A 1 XFAN_LK
-A14 26/ISEL6
-B36 PCI_AD1
-B35 PCI_AD3
-B34 PCI_AD5
-B31 PCI_AD8
-A36 PCI_AD0
-A35 PCI_AD2
-A34 PCI_AD4
-A33 PCI_AD6
-A31 PCI_AD7
-A30 PCI_AD9
-A22 PCI_IRDY
-B30 PCI_AD10
-B29 PCI_AD12
-B28 PCI_AD14
-B21 PCI_AD16
-B20 PCI_AD18
-B19 PCI_AD20
-B17 PCI_AD22
-B15 PCI_AD25
-B14 PCI_AD27
-B12 PCI_AD29
-B11 PCI_AD31
-A29 PCI_AD11
-A28 PCI_AD13
-A26 PCI_AD15
-A20 PCI_AD17
-A19 PCI_AD19
-A17 PCI_AD21
-A16 PCI_AD23
-A15 PCI_AD24
-A12 PCI_AD28
-A11 PCI_AD30
Appendix-7
-B 9 XPCI_REQ0
-B33 PCI_C_BE0
-B26 PCI_C_BE1
-B16 PCI_C_BE3
-A21 PCI_C_BE2
-B25 XPCI_STOP
-B24 XPCI_TRDY
-B22 XPCI_FRAME
-A24 XPCI_DEVSEL
Crimp
Symbol
Connector
IP-424
9
9
Relay connector
Faston
I
F
E
B
A
H
D
C
G
APPENDIX
I
F
E
B
A
H
D
C
G
7.7
APPENDIX
37-1 VEN.TXD
71
24V 21- 6
-2 PGND
72
PGND 21- 5
35-1 -3 VEN.CTS
73
5V 21- 4
35-2 -4 VEN.RXD
74
SGND 21- 3
1
1
35-3 -5 N.C
75
SGND 21- 2
35-4 -6 VEN.RTS
76
12V 21- 1
35-5 -7 PGND
-8 5V
36-1 /M1
77
24V 19- 1
-2 /PF PGND 19- 2
-3 /PS0
78
PGND 19- 3
-4 /PS1
-5 /PS2
-6 /PS3 24V 20- 1
-7 /SIDE
30 31
24V 20- 2
for SW3
-8 /CPF0
COPY VENDER
-9 /CPF1
79
PGND 20- 3
-10 PGND
80
PGND 20- 4
RL CONT 25-A11
81
L2 CONT 25-A10
82
2
2
M1
SGND 14- 1
H/L -7
SGND 14- 2
Main motor
for FCB
P.G -8 23-A4 PGND L3 CONT 14- 3
P.G -9 23-A3 PGND
50 51 52 53
5V 14- 4
24V -10 23-A2 24V
EUROPE only
24V -11 23-A1 24V
86
110-19
5V -1 23-B1 5V
87
110-18
S.G -2 23-B2 SGND
88
110-17
CONT -3 23-B3 CONT
89
110-16
CLK -4 23-B4 CLOCK
90
110-15
CW/CCW-5 23-B5 F/R
91
110-14
LD -6 23-B6 SGND J10:12 - 1
92
110-13
M9
S.FB 15-A1 71-12
H/L -7 J10:11 - 2
93
3
3
110- 1
for
LD -6 31-6 SGND FT31 FT32 FT33
M11
H/L -7 31-5 N.C
DCPS
P.G -8 31-4 PGND
Fixing motor
P.G -9 31-3 PGND
12
11
24V -10 31-2 24V
24V -11 72- 1 J16-11
31-1 24V
PGND
FT30
PLATE
to GUIDE
24V J25-2
HV
J17-8
4
4
CB 1/2
J17-11
FT38 FT39
J25-4 J09-1 70- 9
J09-2 70- 8
J09-3 70- 7
B.CONT 27- 1
J09-4 70- 6
B.SIG 27- 2
FT36 FT37
Separation Transfer
J09-5
PGND 27- 3 70- 5
J17-7 J17-12 J09-6
24V 27- 4 70- 4
J25-1 J25-5
984-1 J05:3 - 1
29-B16 5V
-2 J05:2 - 2 Perdita/Pongo:
sensor
29-B15 TLD ANG N.C 27- 5
Discovery: J09-7 70- 3 73- 3
TLD
-3 J05:1 - 3
29-B14 SGND SGND 27- 6 -3
J09-8 70- 2 73- 2
HUM1 ANG 27- 7 -2
J09-9
HUM1
70- 1 73- 1
5V 27- 8 982-1
954-1 J06:3 - 1
29-B13 5V
Humidity sensor
-2 J06:2 - 2
sensor
29-B12 PS
-3 J06:1 - 3
PS 5
29-B11 SGND
5
5
986-1
29-B10 DRIVE
986-2
TC
29-B9 24V J12: 9 - 1 J13:A4 - A1 980:1 - 1
Fixing
SGND 18- 7
SGND 18- 9
903:6 - 1
sensor/2
29-B6 24V
FUSING UNIT
903:5 - 2
29-B5 24V
temperature temperature
motor/1
29-B3 B PS 18-11
J13:B2 - B3 J18: 1 - 3
PS 2
903:2 - 5 J12: 3 - 7 -3
FS-114
FS-113
29-B2 A 5V 18-12
903:1 - 6 J12: 2 - 8
N.C 18-13
Toner supply
29-B1 A
J12: 1 - 9
N.C 18-14
Fixing exit sensor
915:6 - 1
29-A16 24V
915:5 - 2
29-A15 24V
915:4 - 3
29-A14 B J14: 6 - 1 J17-2 983-1
915:3 - 4 CONT 25-A1
motor/2
J14: 5 - 2 J17-3 -2
M10
6
6
915:1 - 6
TDS
Toner supply
SGND 25-A4
DEV UNIT
J14: 2 -5
N.C 25-A5
J14: 1
920: 2 - 1 N.C 25-A6
clutch
29-A10 DRIVE
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
920: 1 - 2
29-A9 24V
MC1
J15:13 - 1 J16-12
N.C 26-B5
5V
5V
J15:12 - 2 J16-14
N.C
N.C
24V
24V
24V
for DCPS
5V 26-B7
FS CTS
FS RTS
web
SD4
DRUM.TH 26-B8 -6
Cleaning
Registration solenoid
Internal
914: 1 - 3 J38: 4 - 3
105
85 - 7
107
85 - 6
dehumidifying
DRUM CARTRIGE
DRIVE 26-B14 85 - 5
J15: 3 - 11 J16-16 928:1 - 2
109
/SW2
85 - 4
SD7
24V 26-B15
solenoid
912: 3 - 1 J38: 3 - 4
110
29-A3 PGND 85 - 3
7
fan/1
7
912: 2 - 2 J38: 2 - 5
PSW2B
111
29-A2 EM 85 - 2
Internal
912: 1 - 3 J38: 1 - 6
112
PCL
lamp
DRIVE 26-B17
dehumidifying
N.C 26-B18
Separation charging
113
114
911: 3 - 1 J28: 3 - 1
18-5 PGND
fan
911: 2 - 2 J28: 2 - 2
18-4 LOCK
FM2
911: 1 - 3 J28: 1 - 3
Fixing
cooling
18-3 DRIVE
7235 only
514: 2 - 1
514: 1 - 2
927:2 - 1
18-2 24V
927:1 - 2
SD9
18-1 DRIVE
Toner
W 32-3
solenoid
Appendix-8
V 32-2
M2
Speaker
U 32-1
Scanner motor
J42:10- 10
L1
38- 8 SGND
INV1
J42:11- 11
38- 9 IT.SET
8
8
L1INVB
Exposure lamp
PGND 33-4 -1
974-1 J42:4 - 4 L1 EM 33-3 -2
38- 3 5V
-2 J42:5 - 5 L1 CONT 33-2 -3 -3 H.V. 96-3 97-1
38- 4 PS
-3 J42:6 - 6 930-1 L.V. 96-1 97-3
PS25
38- 5 SGND
Crimp
972-1
Symbol
-2 J42:2 - 2
38- 1 PS
IT exit
38- 2 SGND
-2
sensor/U
PS 16-8
PS17
5V 16-7 966-3
APS sensor
973-1
-2
IT exit
Connector
-3
PS24
IT-101
sensor/L
5V 16-6 -1
PS 16-5 -2
sensor
PS15
Gate
38- 7 DRIVE
9
9
solenoid
5V 16-3 -1
PS 16-2 -2
Relay connector
Faston
PS14
I
F
E
B
A
H
D
C
G
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
I
F
E
B
A
H
D
C
G
7.8
958-1 J31:3 - 1
25-B17 5V
-2 J31:2 - 2
25-B16 PS
-3 J31:1 - 3 -4
PS 9
Tray set
25-B15 SGND 24V 35- 1
sensor/U
-2
KC
985B-1
SIG 35- 2
-1 985B-2
1
1
SGND 35- 3
CN985A
CN985B
J32:3 - 1 985A-3
(Option)
961-1
for KC
25-B14 5V DRIVE 35- 4
-2 J32:2 - 2
N.C 35- 5
Key counter
25-B13 PS
-3 J32:1 - 3
Tray set
PS 12
sensor/L
25-B12 SGND
sensor
25-B10 PS
-3 J33:1 - 3 J01:7 - 3
PS 1
25-B9 SGND 201:A1 - A18
5V 17-A18 68-A1
Registration
201:A2 - A17
FM301 EM 17-A17 68-A2
957-1 J01: 6 - 4 201:A3 - A16
25-B8 5V FM301 CONT 17-A16 68-A3
-2 J01: 5 - 5 201:A4 - A15
25-B7 PS SD303 CONT 17-A15 68-A4
-3 J01: 4 - 6 201:A5 - A14
PS 8
sensor
25-B6 SGND VR301 17-A14 68-A5
201:A6 - A13
PS305 17-A13 68-A6
201:A7 - A12
PS304 17-A12 68-A7
956-1 J01: 3 - 7 201:A8 - A11
25-B5 5V PS303 17-A11 68-A8
-2 J01: 2 - 8 201:A9 - A10
25-B4 PS PS302 17-A10 68-A9
sensor
J01: 1 - 9 201:A10- A9
PS 7
-3 PS301 17-A9 68-A10
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
2
2
feed
25-B2 DRIVE 201:A14- A5
923: 1 - 2 M301 RST 17-A5 68-A14
SD2
25-B1 24V 201:A15- A4
M301 EM 17-A4 68-A15
201:A16- A3
M301 F/R 17-A3 68-A16
201:A17- A2
25-A17 N.C SGND 17-A2 68-A17
922: 2 - 1 201:A18- A1
feed
25-A16 24V M301 CLOCK 17-A1 68-A18
922: 1 - 2
SD1
25-A15 DRIVE
201:B1 - B18
SGND 17-B18
solenoid/L solenoid/U
68-B1
201:B2 - B17
J41:3 - 1 M302 CLOCK 17-B17 68-B2
971-3 201:B3 - B16
25-A14 SGND SGND 17-B16 68-B3
-2 J41:2 - 2 201:B4 - B15
25-A13 PS M302 EM 17-B15 68-B4
-1 J41:1 - 3 201:B5 - B14
PS22
25-A12 5V
DF-320
7235/7228 only
201:B7 - B12
SGND 17-B12 68-B7
201:B8 - B11
M303 CLOCK 17-B11 68-B8
924: 2 - 1 J04:11 - 1 201:B9 - B10
24-B19 24V SGND 17-B10 68-B9
924: 1 - 2 J04:10 - 2 201:B10- B9
By-pass
solenoid
SD3
24-B18 DRIVE SD302 DRIVE 17-B9 68-B10
201:B11- B8
PS309 17-B8 68-B11
201:B12- B7
PS308 17-B7 68-B12
969-1 J08: 6 - 1 J04: 9 - 3 201:B13- B6
24-B17 5V PS306 17-B6 68-B13
-2 J08: 5 - 2 J04: 8 - 4 201:B14- B5
24-B16 PS M303 V1 17-B5 68-B14
3
3
PS20
By-pass
24-B15 SGND M303 V0 17-B4 68-B15
201:B16- B3
M302 V1 17-B3 68-B16
201:B17- B2
J08: 3 - 4 J04: 6 - 6 M302 V0 17-B2 68-B17
98 -3 201:B18- B1
SGND
5V
PGND
PGND
24V
24V
7235/7228/7222 Overall Wiring Diagram (4/4)
BYPASS TRAY
VR1
-1 J08: 1 - 6 J04: 4 - 8
By-pass
3
RT3
962-1 J04: 3 - 9
24-B11 5V
-2 J04: 2 - 10
24-B10 PS
-3 J04: 1 - 11
sensor
PS13
24-B9 SGND
By-pass
paper feed tray paper tray paper no paper
200: 1 - 1
200: 2 - 2
200: 3 - 3
200: 4 - 4
200: 5 - 5
200: 6 - 6
913: 3 - 1
3
24-B8 PGND
RT3
913: 2 - 2
24-B7 EM
FM5
913: 1 - 3
24-B6 DRIVE
suction fan
Developing
J54:1 - 4
SGND 39-4
8
6
5
3
2
10
7235 only
J54:2 - 3
N.C 39-3
J54:3 - 2
FM7
EM 39-2
J54:4 - 1
DRIVE 39-1
fan/1
for DCPS
4
4
910: 3 - 1
24-B5 PGND
910: 2 - 2
24-B4 EM
Polygon cooling fan
FM4
910: 1 - 3
24-B3 DRIVE
Internal cooling
921: 2 - 1
24-B2 DRIVE J54:1 - 5 J51:1 - 5
921: 1 - 2 CLOCK 22-5 904-1
MC2
24-B1 24V J54:2 - 4 J51:2 - 4
LCCK 22-4 -2
J54:3 - 3 J51:3 - 3
Loop clutch
CB 2/2
DRIVE 22-3 -3
M5
J54:4 - 2 J51:4 - 2
PGND 22-2 -4
J54:5 - 1 J51:5 - 1
24V 22-1 -5
24-A19 N.C
Polygon motor
J02: 7 - 1
90-1 24-A18 SGND
J02: 6 - 2
-2 24-A17 SIZE.UP.A
J02: 5 - 3
-3 24-A16 SIZE.UP.B
J02: 4 - 4
-4 24-A15 SIZE.UP.C
J02: 3 - 5
-5 24-A14 SIZE.UP.D
PFDB/U
5
5
933:2 - 1 J02: 2 - 6
24-A13 SGND
lamp
1-2 J02: 1 - 7
TSL
24-A12 DRIVE
nization
959-1 J03:11 - 1
24-A11 5V
-2 J03:10 - 2
24-A10 PS
J03: 9 - 3
ADU motor
-3
PS 10
synchro- sensor/L
24-A9 SGND 926:2 - 1
24V 29-B8
DRIVE 29-B7
solenoid
J03: 8 - 4
(JAPAN ONLY)
960-1
ADU gate
24-A8 5V
M6
-2 J03: 7 - 5
24-A7 PS
PS 11 -3 J03: 6 - 6
24-A6 SGND
AD-307
sensor/U
No paper
J03: 5 - 7
905: 1 - 6
905: 2 - 5
905: 3 - 4
905: 4 - 3
905: 5 - 2
905: 6 - 1
J03: 3 - 9
-3 24-A3 SIZE.LOW.B J30:2 - 2 -2
J03: 2 - 10 PS 15-A14
PS 4
-5 24-A1 SIZE.LOW.D
ADU sensor
6
6
15-B15 N.C
15-B14 SGND
41-9 FG
41-2 TX-
41-10 FG
41-8 N.C
41-7 N.C
41-6 RX-
41-5 N.C
41-4 N.C
71-1
71-2
71-3
71-4
71-5
71-6
41-1 TX+
41-3 RX+
15-B13 SGND
41-11 LED2
41-11 LED1
41-11 VDD2
41-11 VDD1
A
A
B
B
15-B12 FS CTS
24V
24V
15-B7 FS RTS
15-B6 N.C 24V 26-A18 70-1
15-B5 SGND 24V 26-A17 70-2
15-B4 FS TXD M6 CONT 26-A16 70-3
70 69 68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60
Timming
sensor/U
7235/7228 only
ADUDB
906-1
26-B4 24V
Tray
-2
M7
26-B3 DRIVE
motor/U
907-1
26-B2 24V
Tray
-2
Appendix-9
M8
26-B1 DRIVE
SCB 3/3
motor/L
J61 : 1 - 9
40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32
Relay connector
Faston
I
F
E
B
A
H
D
C
G
APPENDIX
APPENDIX 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
Symbol Part name Location Symbol Part name Location Symbol Part name Location
COPY VENDER COPY VENDER Appendix-3 1-I M1 Main motor Appendix-3 2-H PS24 IT exit sensor /L Appendix-3 9-H
AD-307 AD-307 Appendix-4 5-C M2 Scanner motor Appendix-3 8-D PS25 IT door sensor Appendix-3 8-H
DB-211 DB-211 Appendix-1 2-G M4 Toner supply motor /1 Appendix-3 5-H TH1 Fixing temperature sensor /1 Appendix-3 5-D
DB-411 DB-411 Appendix-1 2-G M5 Polygon motor Appendix-4 4-A TH2 Fixing temperature sensor /2 Appendix-3 5-D
DF-320 DF-320 Appendix-4 1-B M6 ADU motor Appendix-4 5-D HUM1 Humidity sensor Appendix-3 5-C
DIMM DIMM Appendix-2 3-D M7 Tray motor /U Appendix-4 7-I TDS Toner density sensor Appendix-3 6-D
FK-103/FL-103 FK-103/FL-103 Appendix-2 4-A M8 Tray motor /L Appendix-4 8-I TLD Toner level sensor Appendix-3 5-H
FS-113 FS-113 Appendix-3 5-A M9 Paper feed motor Appendix-3 3-H TS Thermostat Appendix-1 7-A
FS-114 FS-114 Appendix-3 5-A M10 Toner supply motor /2 Appendix-3 6-H SW1 Main power switch Appendix-1 4-C
HD-103 Type A HD-103 Appendix-2 1-D M11 Fixing motor Appendix-4 7-I SW2 Sub power switch Appendix-3 7-A
IP-424 IP-424 Appendix-2 8-D FM1 DCPS cooling fan Appendix-1 4-F SW3 Interlock switch Appendix-1 5-E
IT-101 IT-101 Appendix-3 8-G FM2 Fixing cooling fan Appendix-3 7-H VR1 By-pass tray paper size VR Appendix-4 3-I
KC Key counter Appendix-4 1-D FM3 Internal dehumidifying fan /1 Appendix-3 7-H PTC PTC heater Appendix-1 6-E
LT-203 LT-203 Appendix-3 2-A FM4 Internal cooling fan /1 Appendix-4 4-I BATTERY Battery Appendix-2 1-E
TC Total counter Appendix-3 5-H FM5 Developing suction fan Appendix-4 4-I
ADB A/D conversion board Appendix-2 1-A FM6 Internal dehumidifying fan /2 Appendix-3 7-H
ADUDB ADU drive board Appendix-4 6-C FM7 Polygon cooling fan Appendix-4 4-D
CB Main control board Appendix-3 1-F MC1 Registration clutch Appendix-3 6-H
FCB Fixing control board Appendix-1 5-B MC2 Loop clutch Appendix-4 4-I
INDEX Index sensor board Appendix-2 2-H SD1 1st paper feed solenoid /U Appendix-4 2-I
L1INVB Exposure lamp power supply board Appendix-3 8-D SD2 1st paper feed solenoid /L Appendix-4 2-I
LCDB Display board Appendix-1 5-G SD3 By-pass paper feed solenoid Appendix-4 3-I
LDB LD drive board Appendix-2 1-H SD4 Cleaning web solenoid Appendix-3 6-H
OB Operation board Appendix-1 6-F SD5 ADU gate solenoid Appendix-4 5-D
PAKB Panel key board Appendix-1 4-F SD7 Separation claw solenoid Appendix-3 7-D
PFDB/L Paper feed detection board /L Appendix-4 6-H SD8 Gate solenoid Appendix-3 9-H
PFDB/U Paper feed detection board /U Appendix-4 5-H SD9 Toner solenoid Appendix-3 8-H
PRMB Parameter memory board Appendix-2 4-D PS1 Registration sensor Appendix-4 1-I
PSW2B Power SW2 board Appendix-3 7-A PS2 Fixing exit sensor Appendix-3 6-D
SCB System control board Appendix-1 8-E PS4 ADU sensor Appendix-4 6-D
TCSB Toner control sensor board Appendix-3 6-D PS5 Toner bottle sensor Appendix-3 5-H
DCPS DC power supply unit Appendix-1 1-A PS7 Upper limit sensor /U Appendix-4 2-I
HV High voltage unit Appendix-3 3-D PS8 No paper sensor /L Appendix-4 2-I
INV1 Exposure lamp inverter Appendix-3 8-E PS9 Tray set sensor /U Appendix-4 1-I
INV2 Display inverter Appendix-1 4-I PS10 Upper limit sensor /L Appendix-4 5-I
CBR1 Circuit breaker /1 Appendix-1 2-A PS11 No paper sensor /U Appendix-4 5-I
CBR2 Circuit breaker /2 Appendix-1 2-B PS12 Tray set sensor /L Appendix-4 1-I
NF Noise filter Appendix-1 3-A PS13 By-pass no paper sensor Appendix-4 3-I
L1 Exposure lamp Appendix-3 8-C PS14 Scanner home position sensor Appendix-3 9-D
L2 Fixing heater lamp /1 Appendix-1 7-B PS15 APS timing sensor Appendix-3 9-D
L3 Fixing heater lamp /2 Appendix-1 7-B PS17 APS sensor Appendix-3 8-D
PCL Pre-charging lamp Appendix-3 7-D PS20 By-pass tray paper size sensor Appendix-4 3-I
TSL Transfer synchronization lamp Appendix-4 5-I PS21 Timing sensor /U Appendix-4 7-I
LCD LCD Appendix-1 5-G PS22 Timing sensor /L Appendix-4 2-I
BL Back light Appendix-1 4-H PS23 IT exit sensor /U Appendix-3 8-H
Appendix-10
7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004 APPENDIX
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
A SK-114
A
B B
C C
GND
GND
GND
Chopper Unit Setting Detection
GND
E PK-114 E
F F
G G
H Symbol H
Connector Faston
Crimp Relay connector
I I
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Appendix-11
APPENDIX 7145 series Field Service Ver.4.0 Mar. 2004
Appendix-12